1 | % Conventions: uncross-referenced entries appear first, then
|
---|
2 | % cross-referenced entries. In both groups, entries are sorted by their
|
---|
3 | % title field. Lines like "% A" exist to speed searches. The main
|
---|
4 | % paper on a language uses the language name as the citation key. Other
|
---|
5 | % papers use ``<language name>:'' as a prefix. Please consider leaving
|
---|
6 | % keyword lists and an abstract or comment for future generations, and
|
---|
7 | % put some identification in a contributer field.
|
---|
8 |
|
---|
9 | % Predefined journal names:
|
---|
10 | % acmcs: Computing Surveys acta: Acta Infomatica
|
---|
11 | % cacm: Communications of the ACM
|
---|
12 | % ibmjrd: IBM J. Research & Development ibmsj: IBM Systems Journal
|
---|
13 | % ieeese: IEEE Trans. on Soft. Eng. ieeetc: IEEE Trans. on Computers
|
---|
14 | % ieeetcad: IEEE Trans. on Computer-Aided Design of Integrated Circuits
|
---|
15 | % ipl: Information Processing Letters jacm: Journal of the ACM
|
---|
16 | % jcss: J. Computer & System Sciences scp: Science of Comp. Programming
|
---|
17 | % sicomp: SIAM J. on Computing tocs: ACM Trans. on Comp. Systems
|
---|
18 | % tods: ACM Trans. on Database Sys. tog: ACM Trans. on Graphics
|
---|
19 | % toms: ACM Trans. on Math. Software toois: ACM Trans. on Office Info. Sys.
|
---|
20 | % toplas: ACM Trans. on Prog. Lang. & Sys.
|
---|
21 | % tcs: Theoretical Computer Science
|
---|
22 | @string{ieeepds="IEEE Transactions on Parallel and Distributed Systems"}
|
---|
23 | % @string{ieeepds="IEEE Trans. Parallel Distrib. Syst."}
|
---|
24 | @string{ieeese="IEEE Transactions on Software Engineering"}
|
---|
25 | % @string{ieeese="IEEE Trans. Softw. Eng."}
|
---|
26 | @string{spe="Software---\-Practice and Experience"}
|
---|
27 | % @string{spe="Softw. Pract. Exp."}
|
---|
28 | @string{ccpe="Concurrency and Computation: Practice and Experience"}
|
---|
29 | % @string{ccpe="Concurrency Comput. Pract. Exp."}
|
---|
30 | @string{sigplan="SIGPLAN Notices"}
|
---|
31 | % @string{sigplan="SIGPLAN Not."}
|
---|
32 | @string{joop="Journal of Object-Oriented Programming"}
|
---|
33 | % @string{joop="J. of Object-Oriented Program."}
|
---|
34 | @string{popl="Conference Record of the ACM Symposium on Principles of Programming Languages"}
|
---|
35 | @string{osr="Operating Systems Review"}
|
---|
36 | @string{pldi="Programming Language Design and Implementation"}
|
---|
37 | @string{mathann="Mathematische Annalen"}
|
---|
38 | % @string{mathann="Math. Ann."}
|
---|
39 |
|
---|
40 | % A
|
---|
41 |
|
---|
42 | @incollection{ABC++,
|
---|
43 | keywords = {concurrency, parallel, distributed, C++},
|
---|
44 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
45 | author = {William G. O'Farrell and Frank Ch. Eigler and S. David Pullara and Gregory V. Wilson },
|
---|
46 | title = {{ABC}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
47 | editor = {Gregory V. Wilson and Paul Lu},
|
---|
48 | booktitle = {Parallel Programming in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
49 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
50 | address = {New York},
|
---|
51 | series = {Scientific and Engineering Computation Series},
|
---|
52 | year = 1996,
|
---|
53 | pages = {1-42},
|
---|
54 | }
|
---|
55 |
|
---|
56 | @techreport{CL90abstract,
|
---|
57 | keywords = {},
|
---|
58 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
59 | author = {Luca Cardelli and Xavier Leroy},
|
---|
60 | title = {Abstract Types and the Dot Notation},
|
---|
61 | institution = {Systems Research Center},
|
---|
62 | year = 1990,
|
---|
63 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, CA 94301},
|
---|
64 | number = 56,
|
---|
65 | summary = {
|
---|
66 | The existential types of Mitchell and Plotkin \cite{atet} model
|
---|
67 | abstract types, but their ``open'' notation is unlike the usual dot
|
---|
68 | notation used in programming languages. This paper gives
|
---|
69 | translations between the ``open'' and ``dot'' forms, and suggests
|
---|
70 | extensions for nested and for parameterized abstractions.
|
---|
71 | }
|
---|
72 | }
|
---|
73 |
|
---|
74 | @article{atet,
|
---|
75 | keywords = {lambda calculus, polymorphism},
|
---|
76 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
77 | author = {John C. Mitchell and Gordon D. Plotkin},
|
---|
78 | title = {Abstract Types have Existential Type},
|
---|
79 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
80 | year = 1988,
|
---|
81 | month = jul, volume = 10, number = 3, pages = {470-502},
|
---|
82 | abstract = {
|
---|
83 | Abstract data type declarations appear in typed programming
|
---|
84 | languages like Ada, Alphard, CLU and ML. This form of declaration
|
---|
85 | binds a list of identifiers to a type with associated operations, a
|
---|
86 | composite ``value'' we call a {\em data algebra}. We use a
|
---|
87 | second-order typed lambda calculus SOL to show how data algebras
|
---|
88 | may be given types, passed as parameters, and returned as results of
|
---|
89 | function calls. In the process, we discuss the semantics of
|
---|
90 | abstract data type declarations and review a connection between
|
---|
91 | typed programming languages and constructive logic.
|
---|
92 | }
|
---|
93 | }
|
---|
94 |
|
---|
95 | @article{alphard:intro,
|
---|
96 | keywords = {encapsulation, data abstraction},
|
---|
97 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
98 | author = {Wm. A. Wulf and Ralph L. London and Mary Shaw},
|
---|
99 | title = {Abstraction and Verification in Alphard: Introduction to Language and Methodology},
|
---|
100 | journal = ieeese,
|
---|
101 | year = 1976,
|
---|
102 | month = dec, volume = {SE-2}, number = 4, pages = {253-265},
|
---|
103 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{alphard}.},
|
---|
104 | abstract = {
|
---|
105 | Alphard is a programming language whose goals include supporting
|
---|
106 | both the development of well-structured programs and the formal
|
---|
107 | verification of these programs. This paper attempts to capture the
|
---|
108 | symbiotic influence of these two goals on the design of the
|
---|
109 | language. To that end the language description is interleaved with
|
---|
110 | the presentation of a proof technique and discudssion of
|
---|
111 | programming methodology. Examples to illustrate both the language
|
---|
112 | and the verification technique are included.
|
---|
113 | }
|
---|
114 | }
|
---|
115 |
|
---|
116 | @book{Hilfinger83,
|
---|
117 | keywords = {ada},
|
---|
118 | author = {Paul N. Hilfinger},
|
---|
119 | title = {Abstraction Mechanisms and Language Design},
|
---|
120 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
121 | series = {ACM Distinguished Dissertations},
|
---|
122 | year = 1983,
|
---|
123 | }
|
---|
124 |
|
---|
125 | @incollection{Lavender96,
|
---|
126 | author = {R. Greg Lavender and Douglas C. Schmidt},
|
---|
127 | chapter = {Active Object: An Object Behavioral Pattern for Concurrent Programming},
|
---|
128 | title = {Pattern Languages of Program Design 2},
|
---|
129 | editor = {John M. Vlissides and James O. Coplien and Norman L. Kerth},
|
---|
130 | year = 1996,
|
---|
131 | pages = {483-499},
|
---|
132 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley Longman Publishing},
|
---|
133 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
134 | }
|
---|
135 |
|
---|
136 | @article{Nierstrasz87,
|
---|
137 | keywords = {Hybrid, active objects, object-oriented languages,
|
---|
138 | object-based languages, delegation, concurrency},
|
---|
139 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
140 | author = {O. M. Nierstrasz},
|
---|
141 | title = {Active Objects in {Hybrid}},
|
---|
142 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
143 | volume = 22,
|
---|
144 | number = 12,
|
---|
145 | month = dec,
|
---|
146 | year = 1987,
|
---|
147 | pages = {243-253},
|
---|
148 | note = {Proceedings of the OOPSLA'87 Conference, Oct. 4--8, 1987, Orlando, Florida},
|
---|
149 | abstract = {
|
---|
150 | Most object-oriented languages are strong on reusability or on
|
---|
151 | strong-typing, but weak on concurrency. In response to this gap,
|
---|
152 | we are developing {\it Hybrid}, an object-oriented language in which
|
---|
153 | objects are the active entities. Objects in Hybrid are organized
|
---|
154 | into {\it domains}, and concurrent executions into {\it activities}.
|
---|
155 | All object communications are based on remote procedure calls.
|
---|
156 | Unstructured {\it sends\/} and {\it accepts\/} are forbidden. To
|
---|
157 | this the mechanisms of {\it delegation\/} and {\it delay queues\/}
|
---|
158 | are added to enable switching and triggering of activities.
|
---|
159 | Concurrent subactivities and atomic actions are provided for
|
---|
160 | compactness and simplicity. We show how solutions to many important
|
---|
161 | concurrent problems [sic], such as pipelining, constraint management
|
---|
162 | and ``administration'' can be compactly expressed using these
|
---|
163 | mechanisms.
|
---|
164 | },
|
---|
165 | comment = {Mentions Thoth in reference to delegation}
|
---|
166 | }
|
---|
167 |
|
---|
168 | @book{Actors,
|
---|
169 | keywords = {actors, concurrency},
|
---|
170 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
171 | author = {Gul A. Agha},
|
---|
172 | title = {Actors: A Model of Concurrent Computation in Distributed Systems},
|
---|
173 | publisher = {MIT Press, Cambridge},
|
---|
174 | year = 1986
|
---|
175 | }
|
---|
176 |
|
---|
177 | @article{polymorphImpl,
|
---|
178 | keywords = {Napier88},
|
---|
179 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
180 | author = {R. Morrison and A. Dearle and R. C. H. Connor and A. L. Brown},
|
---|
181 | title = {An Ad Hoc Approach to the Implementation of Polymorphism},
|
---|
182 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
183 | year = 1991,
|
---|
184 | month = jul,
|
---|
185 | volume = 13,
|
---|
186 | number = 3,
|
---|
187 | pages = {342-371},
|
---|
188 | abstract = {
|
---|
189 | Polymorphic abstraction provides the ability to write programs that
|
---|
190 | are independent of the form of the data over which they operate.
|
---|
191 | There are a number of different categories of polymorphic
|
---|
192 | expression---ad hoc and universal, which includes parametric and
|
---|
193 | inclusion---all of which have many advantages in terms of code
|
---|
194 | reuse and software economics. It has proved difficult to provide
|
---|
195 | efficient implementations of polymorphism. Here, we address this
|
---|
196 | problem and describe a new technique that can implement all forms
|
---|
197 | of polymorphism, use a conventional machine architecture, and
|
---|
198 | support nonuniform data representations. Furthermore, the method
|
---|
199 | ensures that any extra cost of implementation applies to
|
---|
200 | polymorphic forms only, and allows such polymorphic forms to
|
---|
201 | persist over program invocations.
|
---|
202 | },
|
---|
203 | summary = {
|
---|
204 | They give three ways to implement polymorphism: {\em textual
|
---|
205 | polymorphism}, which seems to be template instantiation, {\em
|
---|
206 | uniform polymorphism}, which they explain badly, and {\em tagged
|
---|
207 | polymorphism}, where object code performs type tests.
|
---|
208 |
|
---|
209 | They use first-class procedures to implement polymorphism: routines
|
---|
210 | with type parameters are implemented as curried routines that
|
---|
211 | return a nested routine that refers to the type parameter.
|
---|
212 | }
|
---|
213 | }
|
---|
214 |
|
---|
215 | @article{dim:ada,
|
---|
216 | keywords = {Dimensional Analysis, Ada},
|
---|
217 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
218 | author = {Paul N. Hilfinger},
|
---|
219 | title = {An {Ada} Package for Dimensional Analysis},
|
---|
220 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
221 | month = apr,
|
---|
222 | year = 1988,
|
---|
223 | volume = 10,
|
---|
224 | number = 2,
|
---|
225 | pages = {189-203},
|
---|
226 | }
|
---|
227 |
|
---|
228 | @mastersthesis{Younger91,
|
---|
229 | keywords = {concurrency, C++, postponing requests},
|
---|
230 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
231 | author = {Brian M. Younger},
|
---|
232 | title = {Adding Concurrency to {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
233 | school = {University of Waterloo},
|
---|
234 | year = 1991,
|
---|
235 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
236 | }
|
---|
237 |
|
---|
238 | @inproceedings{Buhr92c,
|
---|
239 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
240 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
241 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Glen Ditchfield},
|
---|
242 | title = {Adding Concurrency to a Programming Language},
|
---|
243 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Technical Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
244 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
245 | address = {Portland, Oregon, U.S.A.},
|
---|
246 | month = aug,
|
---|
247 | year = 1992,
|
---|
248 | pages = {207-224},
|
---|
249 | }
|
---|
250 |
|
---|
251 | @article{Buhr89b,
|
---|
252 | keywords = {concurrency, C++},
|
---|
253 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
254 | author = {P. A. Buhr and Glen Ditchfield and C. R. Zarnke},
|
---|
255 | title = {Adding Concurrency to a Statically Type-Safe Object-Oriented Programming Language},
|
---|
256 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
257 | volume = 24,
|
---|
258 | number = 4,
|
---|
259 | month = apr,
|
---|
260 | year = 1989,
|
---|
261 | pages = {18-21},
|
---|
262 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN Workshop on Object-Based Concurrent Programming, Sept. 26--27, 1988, San Diego, California, U.S.A.},
|
---|
263 | }
|
---|
264 |
|
---|
265 | @article{Knuth66,
|
---|
266 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion},
|
---|
267 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
268 | author = {Donald E. Knuth},
|
---|
269 | title = {Additional Comments on a Problem in Concurrent Programming Control},
|
---|
270 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
271 | month = may,
|
---|
272 | year = 1966,
|
---|
273 | volume = 9,
|
---|
274 | number = 5,
|
---|
275 | pages = {321-322},
|
---|
276 | note = {Letter to the Editor}
|
---|
277 | }
|
---|
278 |
|
---|
279 | @article{DeBruijn67,
|
---|
280 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion},
|
---|
281 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
282 | author = {Nicolaas Govert de Bruijn},
|
---|
283 | title = {Additional Comments on a Problem in Concurrent Programming Control},
|
---|
284 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
285 | month = mar,
|
---|
286 | year = 1967,
|
---|
287 | volume = 10,
|
---|
288 | number = 3,
|
---|
289 | pages = {137-138},
|
---|
290 | note = {letter to the Editor}
|
---|
291 | }
|
---|
292 |
|
---|
293 | @phdthesis{Krischer10,
|
---|
294 | author = {Roy Krischer},
|
---|
295 | title = {Advanced Concepts in Asynchronous Exception Handling},
|
---|
296 | school = {University of Waterloo},
|
---|
297 | year = 2010,
|
---|
298 | month = dec,
|
---|
299 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
300 | optnote = {\textsf{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/\-bitstream/10012/\-5751\-/1/Krischer\_Roy.pdf}},
|
---|
301 | note = {\href{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/bitstream/10012/5751/1/Krischer_Roy.pdf}{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/\-bitstream/10012/\-5751\-/1/Krischer\_Roy.pdf}},
|
---|
302 | }
|
---|
303 |
|
---|
304 | @article{Buhr00a,
|
---|
305 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
306 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
307 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and W. Y. Russell Mok},
|
---|
308 | title = {Advanced Exception Handling Mechanisms},
|
---|
309 | journal = ieeese,
|
---|
310 | volume = 26,
|
---|
311 | number = 9,
|
---|
312 | month = sep,
|
---|
313 | year = 2000,
|
---|
314 | pages = {820-836},
|
---|
315 | }
|
---|
316 |
|
---|
317 | @book{Richter97,
|
---|
318 | keywords = {Win32, threads},
|
---|
319 | author = {Jeffrey M. Richter},
|
---|
320 | title = {Advanced Windows},
|
---|
321 | publisher = {Microsoft Press},
|
---|
322 | year = 1997,
|
---|
323 | edition = {3rd},
|
---|
324 | }
|
---|
325 |
|
---|
326 | @article{Francez77,
|
---|
327 | keywords = {parameter passing, named/positional arguments},
|
---|
328 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
329 | author = {Nissim Francez},
|
---|
330 | title = {Another Advantage of Key word Notation for Parameter Communication with Subprograms},
|
---|
331 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
332 | volume = 20,
|
---|
333 | number = 8,
|
---|
334 | month = aug,
|
---|
335 | year = 1977,
|
---|
336 | pages = {604-605},
|
---|
337 | }
|
---|
338 |
|
---|
339 | @manual{Akka,
|
---|
340 | keywords = {Akka actor model},
|
---|
341 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
342 | title = {{A}kka {S}cala Documentation, Release 2.4.11},
|
---|
343 | organization= {Lightbend Inc.},
|
---|
344 | month = sep,
|
---|
345 | year = 2016,
|
---|
346 | note = {\href{http://doc.akka.io/docs/akka/2.4/AkkaScala.pdf}{http://\-doc.akka.io/\-docs/\-akka/\-2.4/\-AkkaScala.pdf}},
|
---|
347 | }
|
---|
348 |
|
---|
349 | @article{Algol60,
|
---|
350 | keywords = {Algol60},
|
---|
351 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
352 | author = {J. W. Backus and F. L. Bauer and J. Green and C. Katz and
|
---|
353 | J. McCarthy and P. Naur and A. J. Perlis and H. Rutishauser and K. Samuelson
|
---|
354 | and B. Vauquois and J.H. Wegstein and A. van Wijngaarden and M. Woodger},
|
---|
355 | title = {Revised Report on the Algorithmic Language Algol 60},
|
---|
356 | editor = {Peter Nauer},
|
---|
357 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
358 | volume = 6,
|
---|
359 | number = 1,
|
---|
360 | month = jan,
|
---|
361 | year = 1963,
|
---|
362 | pages = {1-17},
|
---|
363 | }
|
---|
364 |
|
---|
365 | @article{Mellor-Crummey91,
|
---|
366 | keywords = {spin locks, compare-and-swap, barriers},
|
---|
367 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
368 | author = {John M. Mellor-Crummey and Michael L. Scott},
|
---|
369 | title = {Algorithm for Scalable Synchronization on Shared-Memory Multiprocessors},
|
---|
370 | journal = tocs,
|
---|
371 | volume = 9,
|
---|
372 | number = 1,
|
---|
373 | month = feb,
|
---|
374 | year = 1991,
|
---|
375 | pages = {21-65},
|
---|
376 | }
|
---|
377 |
|
---|
378 | @article{Cormack81,
|
---|
379 | keywords = {},
|
---|
380 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
381 | author = {Gordon V. Cormack},
|
---|
382 | title = {An Algorithm for the Selection of Overloaded Functions in {Ada}},
|
---|
383 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
384 | year = 1981,
|
---|
385 | month = feb, volume = 16, number = 2, pages = {48-52},
|
---|
386 | comment = {
|
---|
387 | A one-pass, top-down algorithm for overload resolution. Input is a
|
---|
388 | parse tree and the desired result type, and output is the number of
|
---|
389 | solutions. For each overloading of the root identifier with a
|
---|
390 | matching parameter list, recursively solve for each parameter for
|
---|
391 | the corresponding argument type---there should be one solution.
|
---|
392 | }
|
---|
393 | }
|
---|
394 |
|
---|
395 | @book{Raynal86,
|
---|
396 | keywords = {mutual exclusion, locks},
|
---|
397 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
398 | author = {M. Raynal},
|
---|
399 | title = {Algorithms for Mutual Exclusion},
|
---|
400 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
401 | address = {Cambridge},
|
---|
402 | series = {Scientific Computation Series},
|
---|
403 | year = 1986,
|
---|
404 | note = {Translated by D. Beeson},
|
---|
405 | }
|
---|
406 |
|
---|
407 | @incollection{Gidenstam05,
|
---|
408 | keywords = {lock free, dynamic memory allocation},
|
---|
409 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
410 | author = {Anders Gidenstam and Marina Papatriantafilou and Philippas Tsigas},
|
---|
411 | title = {Allocating Memory in a Lock-free Manner},
|
---|
412 | editor = {Gerth St{\o}lting Brodal and Stefano Leonardi},
|
---|
413 | booktitle = {Algorithms -- ESA 2005},
|
---|
414 | pages = {329-342},
|
---|
415 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
416 | address = {New York},
|
---|
417 | year = 2005,
|
---|
418 | volume = 3669,
|
---|
419 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
420 | }
|
---|
421 |
|
---|
422 | @book{Sites92,
|
---|
423 | keywords = {computers, Alpha},
|
---|
424 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
425 | editor = {Richard L. Sites},
|
---|
426 | title = {Alpha Architecture Reference Manual},
|
---|
427 | publisher = {Digital Press, Burlington},
|
---|
428 | year = 1992,
|
---|
429 | }
|
---|
430 |
|
---|
431 | @book{alphard,
|
---|
432 | keywords = {Parametric polymorphism, alphard, iterators, nested types},
|
---|
433 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
434 | editor = {Mary Shaw},
|
---|
435 | title = {{ALPHARD}: Form and Content},
|
---|
436 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
437 | address = {New York},
|
---|
438 | year = 1981,
|
---|
439 | comment = {Collection of papers about Alphard.}
|
---|
440 | }
|
---|
441 |
|
---|
442 | @article{Kessels77,
|
---|
443 | keywords = {monitors},
|
---|
444 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
445 | author = {Joep L. W. Kessels},
|
---|
446 | title = {An Alternative to Event Queues for Synchronization in Monitors},
|
---|
447 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
448 | volume = 20,
|
---|
449 | number = 7,
|
---|
450 | month = jul,
|
---|
451 | year = 1977,
|
---|
452 | pages = {500-503},
|
---|
453 | annote = {
|
---|
454 | }
|
---|
455 | }
|
---|
456 |
|
---|
457 | @article{descr,
|
---|
458 | keywords = {X2, subclasses, inheritance, parameterized classes},
|
---|
459 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
460 | author = {David Sandberg},
|
---|
461 | title = {An Alternative to Subclassing},
|
---|
462 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
463 | volume = {21}, number = {11},
|
---|
464 | pages = {424-428},
|
---|
465 | month = nov, year = 1986,
|
---|
466 | comment = {
|
---|
467 | The Smalltalk class hierarchy has three uses: factoring out code;
|
---|
468 | ``Abstraction superclasses'' such as Collection; rapid construction
|
---|
469 | of new classes by incremental change.
|
---|
470 |
|
---|
471 | ``A descriptive class specifies a partial behavior by specifying a
|
---|
472 | set of procedure headings that describe what can be done with
|
---|
473 | instances of classes that belong to the descriptive class.'' An
|
---|
474 | ``instance'' statement declares a class to be an instance of a
|
---|
475 | descriptive class and defines the correspondence between
|
---|
476 | operations. Procedures with descriptive class parameters take any
|
---|
477 | instance as arguments. Descriptive classes can describe relations
|
---|
478 | like ``c is a collection with element type e'', but how such things
|
---|
479 | are used isn't explained.
|
---|
480 |
|
---|
481 | For each descriptive class used in a parameter list, an implicit
|
---|
482 | parameter is created that is passed a vector of procedures.
|
---|
483 | }
|
---|
484 | }
|
---|
485 |
|
---|
486 | @incollection{Matsuoka93,
|
---|
487 | keywords = {inheritance anomaly},
|
---|
488 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
489 | author = {Satoshi Matsuoka and Akinori Yonezawa},
|
---|
490 | title = {Analysis of Inheritance Anomaly in Object-Oriented Concurrent Programming Languages},
|
---|
491 | booktitle = {Research Directions in Concurrent Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
492 | editor = {Gul Agha and Peter Wegner and Akinori Yonezawa},
|
---|
493 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
494 | address = {New York},
|
---|
495 | year = 1993,
|
---|
496 | pages = {107-150},
|
---|
497 | }
|
---|
498 |
|
---|
499 | @article{Sinha00,
|
---|
500 | author = {Saurabh Sinha and Mary Jean Harrold},
|
---|
501 | title = {Analysis and Testing of Programs with Exception-Handling Constructs},
|
---|
502 | journal = ieeese,
|
---|
503 | year = 2000,
|
---|
504 | month = sep,
|
---|
505 | volume = 26,
|
---|
506 | number = 9,
|
---|
507 | pages = {849--871},
|
---|
508 | }
|
---|
509 |
|
---|
510 | @inproceedings{Robillard99,
|
---|
511 | author = {Martin P. Robillard and Gail C. Murphy},
|
---|
512 | title = {Analyzing Exception Flow in {J}ava Programs},
|
---|
513 | booktitle = {ESEC/FSE-7: Proceedings of the 7th European Software Engineering Conference held jointly
|
---|
514 | with the 7th ACM SIGSOFT International Symposium on Foundations of Software Engineering},
|
---|
515 | year = 1999,
|
---|
516 | pages = {322--337},
|
---|
517 | isbn = {3-540-66538-2},
|
---|
518 | location = {Toulouse, France},
|
---|
519 | doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/318773.319251},
|
---|
520 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
521 | address = {London, UK},
|
---|
522 | }
|
---|
523 |
|
---|
524 | @book{C++,
|
---|
525 | keywords = {C++, ANSI},
|
---|
526 | author = {Margaret A. Ellis and Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
527 | title = {The Annotated {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Reference Manual},
|
---|
528 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
529 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
530 | year = 1990,
|
---|
531 | edition = {1st},
|
---|
532 | }
|
---|
533 |
|
---|
534 | @book{APL,
|
---|
535 | keywords = {APL},
|
---|
536 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
537 | author = {K. E. Iverson},
|
---|
538 | title = {A Programming Language},
|
---|
539 | publisher = {Wiley, New York},
|
---|
540 | year = 1962
|
---|
541 | }
|
---|
542 |
|
---|
543 | @article{PS-Algol:old,
|
---|
544 | author = {M. Atkinson and P. Bailey and K. Chisholm and P. Cockshott and R. Morrison},
|
---|
545 | title = {An Approach to Persistent Programming},
|
---|
546 | journal = {The Computer Journal},
|
---|
547 | year = 1983,
|
---|
548 | volume = 26,
|
---|
549 | number = 4,
|
---|
550 | pages = {360-365},
|
---|
551 | }
|
---|
552 |
|
---|
553 | @article{Kessels82,
|
---|
554 | keywords = {concurrency, critical section},
|
---|
555 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
556 | author = {Joep L. W. Kessels},
|
---|
557 | title = {Arbitration Without Common Modifiable Variables},
|
---|
558 | journal = acta,
|
---|
559 | volume = 17,
|
---|
560 | number = 2,
|
---|
561 | month = jun,
|
---|
562 | year = 1982,
|
---|
563 | pages = {135-141},
|
---|
564 | }
|
---|
565 |
|
---|
566 | @article{Buhr95a,
|
---|
567 | keywords = {concurrency, library approach},
|
---|
568 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
569 | author = {Peter A. Buhr},
|
---|
570 | title = {Are Safe Concurrency Libraries Possible?},
|
---|
571 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
572 | month = feb,
|
---|
573 | year = 1995,
|
---|
574 | volume = 38,
|
---|
575 | number = 2,
|
---|
576 | pages = {117-120},
|
---|
577 | }
|
---|
578 |
|
---|
579 | @book{ARMv7,
|
---|
580 | key = {ARM processor},
|
---|
581 | title = {ARM Architecture Reference Manual},
|
---|
582 | publisher = {ARM},
|
---|
583 | volume = {ARM DDI 0406C.b (ID072512)},
|
---|
584 | year = 2012,
|
---|
585 | }
|
---|
586 |
|
---|
587 | @book{Herlihy08,
|
---|
588 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
589 | author = {Herlihy, Maurice and Shavit, Nir},
|
---|
590 | title = {The Art of Multiprocessor Programming},
|
---|
591 | year = 2008,
|
---|
592 | isbn = {0123705916, 9780123705914},
|
---|
593 | publisher = {Morgan Kaufmann Publishers},
|
---|
594 | address = {San Francisco},
|
---|
595 | }
|
---|
596 |
|
---|
597 | @inproceedings{Chung10,
|
---|
598 | keywords = {transactional memory, lock-free programming, x86 architecture},
|
---|
599 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
600 | author = {Jaewoong Chung and Luke Yen and Stephan Diestelhorst and Martin Pohlack and Michael Hohmuth and David Christie and Dan Grossman},
|
---|
601 | title = {ASF: AMD64 Extension for Lock-Free Data Structures and Transactional Memory},
|
---|
602 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 2010 43rd Annual IEEE/ACM International Symposium on Microarchitecture},
|
---|
603 | series = {MICRO '43},
|
---|
604 | year = 2010,
|
---|
605 | pages = {39--50},
|
---|
606 | numpages = {12},
|
---|
607 | publisher = {IEEE Computer Society},
|
---|
608 | address = {Washington, DC, USA},
|
---|
609 | }
|
---|
610 |
|
---|
611 | @article{Buhr94a,
|
---|
612 | keywords = {assignment, parameter passing, multiple assignment},
|
---|
613 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
614 | author = {P. A. Buhr and David Till and C. R. Zarnke},
|
---|
615 | title = {Assignment as the Sole Means of Updating Objects},
|
---|
616 | journal = spe,
|
---|
617 | month = sep,
|
---|
618 | year = 1994,
|
---|
619 | volume = 24,
|
---|
620 | number = 9,
|
---|
621 | pages = {835-870},
|
---|
622 | }
|
---|
623 |
|
---|
624 | @inproceedings{Krischer08,
|
---|
625 | keywords = {exception handling, asynchronous, blocked tasks},
|
---|
626 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
627 | author = {Roy Krischer and Peter A. Buhr},
|
---|
628 | title = {Asynchronous Exception Propagation in Blocked Tasks},
|
---|
629 | booktitle = {4th International Workshop on Exception Handling (WEH.08)},
|
---|
630 | organization= {16th International Symposium on the Foundations of Software Engineering (FSE 16)},
|
---|
631 | address = {Atlanta, U.S.A},
|
---|
632 | month = nov,
|
---|
633 | year = 2008,
|
---|
634 | pages = {8-15},
|
---|
635 | }
|
---|
636 |
|
---|
637 | @article{oop:modpascal,
|
---|
638 | keywords = {ModPascal},
|
---|
639 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
640 | author = {Walter G. Olthoff},
|
---|
641 | title = {Augmentation of Object-Oriented Programming by Concepts of Abstract Data Type Theory: The ModPascal Experience},
|
---|
642 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
643 | volume = 21,
|
---|
644 | number = 11,
|
---|
645 | pages = {429-443},
|
---|
646 | month = nov,
|
---|
647 | year = 1986
|
---|
648 | }
|
---|
649 |
|
---|
650 | @inproceedings{Shen91,
|
---|
651 | keywords = {Ada, polymorphism},
|
---|
652 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
653 | author = {Jun Shen and Gordon V. Cormack},
|
---|
654 | title = {Automatic instantiation in Ada},
|
---|
655 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the ACM Tri-Ada Conference},
|
---|
656 | organization= {ACM},
|
---|
657 | address = {San Jose, California, U.S.A},
|
---|
658 | month = oct,
|
---|
659 | year = 1991,
|
---|
660 | pages = {338-346},
|
---|
661 | }
|
---|
662 |
|
---|
663 | @article{Havender68,
|
---|
664 | keywords = {deadlock},
|
---|
665 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
666 | author = {J. W. Havender},
|
---|
667 | title = {Avoiding Deadlock in Multitasking Systems},
|
---|
668 | journal = ibmsj,
|
---|
669 | volume = 7,
|
---|
670 | number = 2,
|
---|
671 | year = 1968,
|
---|
672 | pages = {74-84},
|
---|
673 | }
|
---|
674 |
|
---|
675 | % B
|
---|
676 |
|
---|
677 | @incollection{beta:old,
|
---|
678 | keywords = {beta, patterns, virtual types},
|
---|
679 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
680 | author = {Bent Bruun Kristensen and Ole Lehrmann Madsen and Birger M{\o}ller-Pedersen and Kristen Nygaard},
|
---|
681 | title = {The BETA Programming Language},
|
---|
682 | booktitle = {Research Directions in Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
683 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
684 | series = {Computer Systems Series},
|
---|
685 | year = 1987,
|
---|
686 | pages = {7-48},
|
---|
687 | editor = {Bruce Shriver and Peter Wegner}
|
---|
688 | }
|
---|
689 |
|
---|
690 | @article{Knudsen87,
|
---|
691 | keyword = {static exception handling mechanism, BETA, sequel},
|
---|
692 | contributor = {wyrmok@plg},
|
---|
693 | author = {J{\o}rgen Lindskov Knudsen},
|
---|
694 | title = {Better Exception Handling in Block Structured Systems},
|
---|
695 | journal = {IEEE Software},
|
---|
696 | year = 1987,
|
---|
697 | month = may,
|
---|
698 | volume = 4,
|
---|
699 | number = 3,
|
---|
700 | pages = {40-49},
|
---|
701 | comments = {
|
---|
702 | Going up the call hierarchy to look for a handler does not fit an
|
---|
703 | otherwise statically scoped language. Also, not knowing which handler
|
---|
704 | to be used when raising an abnormal event is seen as a weakness of the
|
---|
705 | (dynamic) exception handling mechanism. Knudsen believed that raising
|
---|
706 | an exception should specify the handler for the exception -- the
|
---|
707 | handler is chosen when the exception is raised. However, I don't think
|
---|
708 | his scheme can solve the problem, especially with all the callback
|
---|
709 | routines commonly found in OO programming.
|
---|
710 |
|
---|
711 | BETA exception handling mechanism uses his work as a foundation.
|
---|
712 | However, I don't see any benefits BETA has over other language that is
|
---|
713 | a direct consequence of Knudsen's work. On the other hand, my knowledge
|
---|
714 | on BETA is very limited.
|
---|
715 | }
|
---|
716 | }
|
---|
717 |
|
---|
718 | @book{BCPL,
|
---|
719 | keywords = {BCPL},
|
---|
720 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
721 | author = {M. Richards and C. Whitby-Strevens},
|
---|
722 | title = {{BCPL} -- The Language and Its Compiler},
|
---|
723 | publisher = {Cambridge University Press, Cambridge},
|
---|
724 | year = 1979,
|
---|
725 | }
|
---|
726 |
|
---|
727 | @incollection{Madsen87,
|
---|
728 | keywords = {nested classes},
|
---|
729 | contributer = {pabuhr@watmsg},
|
---|
730 | author = {Ole Lehrmann Madsen},
|
---|
731 | title = {Block Structure and Object Oriented Languages},
|
---|
732 | booktitle = {Research Directions in Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
733 | editor = {Bruce Shriver and Peter Wegner},
|
---|
734 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
735 | series = {Computer Systems Series},
|
---|
736 | year = 1987,
|
---|
737 | pages = {113-128}
|
---|
738 | }
|
---|
739 |
|
---|
740 | @inproceedings{booleanClasses,
|
---|
741 | keywords = {specifications},
|
---|
742 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
743 | author = {David McAllester and Ramin Zabih},
|
---|
744 | title = {Boolean Classes},
|
---|
745 | crossref = "OOPSLA86",
|
---|
746 | pages = {417-423},
|
---|
747 | abstract = {
|
---|
748 | We extend the notion of class so that any Boolean combination of
|
---|
749 | classes is also a class. Boolean classes allow greater precision
|
---|
750 | and conciseness in naming the class of objects governed a
|
---|
751 | particular method [sic]. A class can be viewed as a predicate
|
---|
752 | which is either true or false of any given object. Unlike
|
---|
753 | predicates however classes have an inheritance hierarchy which is
|
---|
754 | known at compile time. Boolean classes extend the notion of class,
|
---|
755 | making classes more like predicates, while preserving the compile
|
---|
756 | time computable inheritance hierarchy.
|
---|
757 | },
|
---|
758 | comment = {
|
---|
759 | Classes are predicates; if object {\tt o} is in class {\tt C}, then
|
---|
760 | {\tt C} is true of {\tt o}. Classes are combined with {\tt :AND},
|
---|
761 | {\tt :OR}, and {\tt :NOT}. Inheritance is treated as implication:
|
---|
762 | {\tt (:implies C E)} means that if class {\tt C} is true of {\tt
|
---|
763 | o}, class expression {\tt E} is true of {\tt o}, so if {\tt E} is a
|
---|
764 | class, it is a superclass of {\tt C}. Some class expressions, i.e.
|
---|
765 | {\tt (:OR c1 c2)}, can't be instantiated. Others, i.e. {\tt (:NOT
|
---|
766 | c)}, can't be given methods or members because almost all classes
|
---|
767 | would inherit them, violating modularity. The rules for spotting
|
---|
768 | these problems are complex. Determining if one class inherits from
|
---|
769 | another needs an exponential algorithm.
|
---|
770 | }
|
---|
771 | }
|
---|
772 |
|
---|
773 | @misc{BoostCoroutines15,
|
---|
774 | keywords = {Boost Coroutine Library},
|
---|
775 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
776 | author = {Oliver Kowalke},
|
---|
777 | title = {Boost Coroutine Library},
|
---|
778 | year = 2015,
|
---|
779 | note = {\href{http://www.boost.org/doc/libs/1_61_0/libs/coroutine/doc/html/index.html}
|
---|
780 | {{http://www.boost.org/\-doc/\-libs/1\_61\_0/\-libs/\-coroutine/\-doc/\-html/\-index.html}} [Accessed September 2016]},
|
---|
781 | }
|
---|
782 |
|
---|
783 | @mastersthesis{Krischer02,
|
---|
784 | author = {Roy Krischer },
|
---|
785 | title = {Bound Exceptions in Object-Oriented Programming Languages},
|
---|
786 | school = {Universit\"at Mannheim},
|
---|
787 | address = {Mannheim, Deutschland},
|
---|
788 | year = 2002,
|
---|
789 | month = oct,
|
---|
790 | type = {Diplomarbeit},
|
---|
791 | note = {{\small\textsf{ftp://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-pub/\-theses/\-KrischerThesis.ps.gz}}},
|
---|
792 | }
|
---|
793 |
|
---|
794 | @inproceedings{Buhr03,
|
---|
795 | keywords = {exception handling, bound handler},
|
---|
796 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
797 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Roy Krischer},
|
---|
798 | title = {Bound Exceptions in Object Programming},
|
---|
799 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the ECOOP 2003 Workshop on Exception Handling in Object Oriented Systems:
|
---|
800 | Towards Emerging Application Areas and New Programming Paradigms},
|
---|
801 | organization= {ECOOP},
|
---|
802 | address = {Darmstadt, Germany},
|
---|
803 | month = jul,
|
---|
804 | year = 2003,
|
---|
805 | pages = {20-26},
|
---|
806 | }
|
---|
807 | % note = {http://www.cs.umn.edu/research/technical_reports.php/listing/technical_reports.php?page=report&report_id=03-028}
|
---|
808 |
|
---|
809 | @inproceedings{Buhr06b,
|
---|
810 | keywords = {exception handling, bound exceptions},
|
---|
811 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Roy Krischer},
|
---|
812 | title = {Bound Exceptions in Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
813 | editor = {C. Dony and J. L. Knudsen and A. Romanovsky and A. Tripathi},
|
---|
814 | booktitle = {Advanced Topics in Exception Handling Techniques},
|
---|
815 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
816 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
817 | volume = 4119,
|
---|
818 | year = 2006,
|
---|
819 | pages = {1-21}
|
---|
820 | }
|
---|
821 |
|
---|
822 | % C
|
---|
823 |
|
---|
824 | @book{C,
|
---|
825 | keywords = {C},
|
---|
826 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
827 | author = {Brian W. Kernighan and Dennis M. Ritchie},
|
---|
828 | title = {The {C} Programming Language},
|
---|
829 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
830 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
831 | year = 1988,
|
---|
832 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
833 | series = {Prentice-Hall Software Series},
|
---|
834 | comment = {
|
---|
835 | based on draft-proposed ANSI C
|
---|
836 | }
|
---|
837 | }
|
---|
838 |
|
---|
839 | @book{C:old,
|
---|
840 | keywords = {C},
|
---|
841 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
842 | author = {Brian W. Kernighan and Dennis M. Ritchie},
|
---|
843 | title = {The {C} Programming Language},
|
---|
844 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
845 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
846 | year = 1978,
|
---|
847 | edition = {1st},
|
---|
848 | }
|
---|
849 |
|
---|
850 | @manual{ANSI89:C,
|
---|
851 | keywords = {ANSI C 89},
|
---|
852 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
853 | title = {American National Standard for Information Systems -- Programming Language -- {C}},
|
---|
854 | organization= {American National Standards Institute},
|
---|
855 | address = {1430 Broadway, New York, New York 10018},
|
---|
856 | month = dec,
|
---|
857 | year = 1989,
|
---|
858 | note = {X3.159-1989}
|
---|
859 | }
|
---|
860 |
|
---|
861 | @manual{C11,
|
---|
862 | keywords = {ISO/IEC C 11},
|
---|
863 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
864 | key = {C11},
|
---|
865 | title = {American National Standard Information technology -- Programming Languages -- {C}},
|
---|
866 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 9899-2011[2012]},
|
---|
867 | publisher = {International Standard Organization},
|
---|
868 | address = {http://www.iso.org},
|
---|
869 | year = 2012,
|
---|
870 | }
|
---|
871 |
|
---|
872 | @manual{C++Concepts,
|
---|
873 | keywords = {ISO/IEC TS 19217:2015},
|
---|
874 | contributer = {a3moss@uwaterloo.ca},
|
---|
875 | key = {C++ Concepts},
|
---|
876 | title = {Information technology -- Programming languages -- {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Extensions for concepts},
|
---|
877 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC TS 19217:2015},
|
---|
878 | publisher = {International Standard Organization},
|
---|
879 | address = {http://www.iso.org},
|
---|
880 | year = 2015
|
---|
881 | }
|
---|
882 |
|
---|
883 | @mastersthesis{Esteves04,
|
---|
884 | keywords = {Cforall, parametric polymorphism, overloading},
|
---|
885 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
886 | author = {Rodolfo Gabriel Esteves},
|
---|
887 | title = {C$\forall$, a Study in Evolutionary Design in Programming Languages},
|
---|
888 | school = {School of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
889 | year = 2004,
|
---|
890 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
891 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/theses/EstevesThesis.pdf}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-theses/\-EstevesThesis.pdf}},
|
---|
892 | }
|
---|
893 |
|
---|
894 | @inproceedings{c++scheme,
|
---|
895 | keywords = {},
|
---|
896 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
897 | author = {Vincent F. Russo and Simon M. Kaplan},
|
---|
898 | title = {A {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Interpreter for {S}cheme},
|
---|
899 | booktitle = {Usenix {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference},
|
---|
900 | year = 1988,
|
---|
901 | pages = {95-108},
|
---|
902 | summary = {
|
---|
903 | The SIOD interpreter for a Scheme subset, written in C, has a
|
---|
904 | tagged union representing data objects, and read(), eval(), and
|
---|
905 | print() functions that are basically large switch statements that
|
---|
906 | switch based on the tag. The authors rewrote it to use a class
|
---|
907 | with virtual read(), eval(), and print() members, without changing
|
---|
908 | any algorithms. The result was more modular, more easily
|
---|
909 | extensible, more reliable, and slightly faster.
|
---|
910 | },
|
---|
911 | comment = {
|
---|
912 | The evidence given is thin.
|
---|
913 | }
|
---|
914 | }
|
---|
915 |
|
---|
916 | @article{doskernel,
|
---|
917 | keywords = {light weight processes},
|
---|
918 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
919 | author = {Tom Green},
|
---|
920 | title = {A {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Multitasking Kernel},
|
---|
921 | journal = {Dr. Dobb's Journal of Software Tools},
|
---|
922 | year = 1989,
|
---|
923 | month = feb, volume = 14, number = 2, pages = {45-51},
|
---|
924 | comment = {
|
---|
925 | A light-weight multitasking kernel for MS-DOS. A task\_control
|
---|
926 | object holds task objects, which may block themselves on signal
|
---|
927 | objects. Task switching is normally preemptive, but tasks can turn
|
---|
928 | off preemption before calling non-reentrant routines. Source code
|
---|
929 | is given.
|
---|
930 | }
|
---|
931 | }
|
---|
932 |
|
---|
933 | @inproceedings{Doeppner87,
|
---|
934 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
935 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
936 | author = {Thomas W. Doeppner and Alan J. Gebele},
|
---|
937 | title = {{C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} on a Parallel Machine},
|
---|
938 | booktitle = {Proceedings and Additional Papers {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Workshop},
|
---|
939 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
940 | address = {Santa Fe, New Mexico, U.S.A},
|
---|
941 | month = nov,
|
---|
942 | year = 1987,
|
---|
943 | pages = {94-107},
|
---|
944 | }
|
---|
945 |
|
---|
946 | @book{Lippman91,
|
---|
947 | keywords = {C++},
|
---|
948 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
949 | author = {Stanley B. Lippman},
|
---|
950 | title = {{C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Primer},
|
---|
951 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
952 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
953 | year = 1991,
|
---|
954 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
955 | note = {QA76.73.C15L57},
|
---|
956 | }
|
---|
957 |
|
---|
958 | @book{c++:v1,
|
---|
959 | keywords = {C++},
|
---|
960 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
961 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
962 | title = {The {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Programming Language},
|
---|
963 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
964 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
965 | year = 1986,
|
---|
966 | edition = {1st},
|
---|
967 | series = {Addison-Wesley Series in Computer Science}
|
---|
968 | }
|
---|
969 |
|
---|
970 | @book{c++:v2,
|
---|
971 | keywords = {C++},
|
---|
972 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
973 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
974 | title = {The {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Programming Language},
|
---|
975 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
976 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
977 | year = 1991,
|
---|
978 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
979 | }
|
---|
980 |
|
---|
981 | @book{c++:v3,
|
---|
982 | keywords = {C++},
|
---|
983 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
984 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
985 | title = {The {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Programming Language},
|
---|
986 | publisher = {Addison Wesley Longman},
|
---|
987 | year = 1997,
|
---|
988 | edition = {3rd},
|
---|
989 | }
|
---|
990 |
|
---|
991 | @manual{Csharp,
|
---|
992 | keywords = {C#},
|
---|
993 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
994 | title = {C\# Language Specification, Standard ECMA-334},
|
---|
995 | organization= {ECMA International Standardizing Information and Communication Systems},
|
---|
996 | month = jun,
|
---|
997 | year = 2006,
|
---|
998 | edition = {4th},
|
---|
999 | }
|
---|
1000 |
|
---|
1001 | @article{Buhr85,
|
---|
1002 | keywords = {goto, multi-exit loop},
|
---|
1003 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1004 | author = {P. A. Buhr},
|
---|
1005 | title = {A Case for Teaching Multi-exit Loops to Beginning Programmers},
|
---|
1006 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
1007 | volume = 20,
|
---|
1008 | number = 11,
|
---|
1009 | month = nov,
|
---|
1010 | year = 1985,
|
---|
1011 | pages = {14-22}
|
---|
1012 | }
|
---|
1013 |
|
---|
1014 | @techreport{cforall-ug,
|
---|
1015 | keywords = {cforall, user guide},
|
---|
1016 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1017 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Glen Ditchfield and David Till and Charles R. Zarnke},
|
---|
1018 | title = {\mbox{\mdseries\sffamily C{$\mathbf{\forall}$}}\ Users Guide, Version 0.1},
|
---|
1019 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
1020 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
1021 | month = oct,
|
---|
1022 | year = 2001,
|
---|
1023 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/~cforall/cfa.ps}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-\char`\~cforall/\-cfa.ps}},
|
---|
1024 | }
|
---|
1025 |
|
---|
1026 | @manual{cforall,
|
---|
1027 | keywords = {polymorphism},
|
---|
1028 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1029 | author = {Glen Ditchfield},
|
---|
1030 | title = {Cforall Reference Manual and Rationale},
|
---|
1031 | edition = {Revision 1.82},
|
---|
1032 | month = jan,
|
---|
1033 | year = 1998,
|
---|
1034 | note = {{\small\textsf{ftp://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-pub/\-Cforall/\-refrat.ps.gz}}},
|
---|
1035 | }
|
---|
1036 |
|
---|
1037 | @book{Yourdon79,
|
---|
1038 | keywords = {software engineering},
|
---|
1039 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1040 | editor = {Edward Nash Yourdon},
|
---|
1041 | title = {Classics in Software Engineering},
|
---|
1042 | publisher = {Yourdon Press},
|
---|
1043 | address = {New York},
|
---|
1044 | year = 1979,
|
---|
1045 | }
|
---|
1046 |
|
---|
1047 | @inproceedings{Crnogorac98,
|
---|
1048 | keywords = {inheritance anomaly},
|
---|
1049 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1050 | author = {Lobel Crnogorac and Anand S. Rao and Kotagiri Ramamohanarao},
|
---|
1051 | title = {Classifying Inheritance Mechanisms in Concurrent Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
1052 | editor = {Eric Jul},
|
---|
1053 | booktitle = {{ECOOP}~'98---Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
1054 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
1055 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
1056 | volume = 1445,
|
---|
1057 | year = 1998,
|
---|
1058 | pages = {571-601},
|
---|
1059 | ISBN = {3-540-64737-6},
|
---|
1060 | ISSN = {0302-9743},
|
---|
1061 | abstract = {
|
---|
1062 | Inheritance is one of the key concepts in object-oriented rogramming. However, the
|
---|
1063 | usefulness of inheritance in concurrent object-oriented programming is greatly
|
---|
1064 | reduced by the problem of inheritance anomaly. Inheritance anomaly is manifested
|
---|
1065 | by undesirable re-definitions of inherited code. The problem is aggravated by the
|
---|
1066 | lack of a formal analysis, with a multitude of differing proposals and conflicting
|
---|
1067 | opinions causing the current state of research, and further directions, to be
|
---|
1068 | unclear. In this paper we present a formal analysis of inheritance anomaly in
|
---|
1069 | concurrent object-oriented programming. Starting from a formal definition of the
|
---|
1070 | problem we develop a taxonomy of the anomaly, and use it to classify the various
|
---|
1071 | proposals. As a result, the major ideas, trends and limitations of the various
|
---|
1072 | proposals are clearly exposed. Formal analysis of the anomaly and a thorough
|
---|
1073 | exposition of its causes and implications are the pre-requisites for a successful
|
---|
1074 | integration of inheritance and concurrency.
|
---|
1075 | },
|
---|
1076 | }
|
---|
1077 |
|
---|
1078 | @book{CLU,
|
---|
1079 | keywords = {CLU},
|
---|
1080 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1081 | author = {Barbara Liskov and Russell Atkinson and Toby Bloom and Eliot
|
---|
1082 | Moss and J. Craig Schaffert and Robert Scheifler and Alan Snyder},
|
---|
1083 | title = {CLU Reference Manual},
|
---|
1084 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
1085 | address = {New York},
|
---|
1086 | year = 1981,
|
---|
1087 | volume = 114,
|
---|
1088 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}
|
---|
1089 | }
|
---|
1090 |
|
---|
1091 | @manual{Cobol14,
|
---|
1092 | keywords = {ISO/IEC Cobol 14},
|
---|
1093 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1094 | key = {Cobol14},
|
---|
1095 | title = {Programming Languages -- {Cobol}},
|
---|
1096 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
1097 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 1989:2014},
|
---|
1098 | publisher = {International Standard Organization},
|
---|
1099 | address = {http://www.iso.org},
|
---|
1100 | year = 2014,
|
---|
1101 | }
|
---|
1102 |
|
---|
1103 | @article{coagulation,
|
---|
1104 | keywords = {register allocation, instruction selection, jello},
|
---|
1105 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1106 | author = {Michael Karr},
|
---|
1107 | title = {Code Generation by Coagulation},
|
---|
1108 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
1109 | year = 1984,
|
---|
1110 | month = jun, volume = 19, number = 6, pages = {1-12},
|
---|
1111 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN '84 Symposium on Compiler Construction},
|
---|
1112 | abstract = {
|
---|
1113 | This paper describes a new approach to code-generation. The
|
---|
1114 | central tenet is that there must be a more intimate coupling
|
---|
1115 | between register allocation and instruction selection than exists
|
---|
1116 | in present-day technology. This is achieved by generating code in
|
---|
1117 | very small regions and gradually coalescing the part of the program
|
---|
1118 | that is ``compiled''.
|
---|
1119 | },
|
---|
1120 | comment = {
|
---|
1121 | Imagine the program, including the subroutines, spread out over a
|
---|
1122 | table, with the compiler dropping Jello on the parts as they are
|
---|
1123 | compiled. At first little drops appear in seemingly random places.
|
---|
1124 | These get bigger and combine with other drops to form growing
|
---|
1125 | globs. When two globs meet, ripples will go out through each as
|
---|
1126 | they adjust to each other's presence, although the parts of the
|
---|
1127 | globs that formed first are less affected by the ripples. When
|
---|
1128 | compilation is complete, there is one congealed mass.
|
---|
1129 | }
|
---|
1130 | }
|
---|
1131 |
|
---|
1132 | @article{Soloway83,
|
---|
1133 | keywords = {goto, structure programming},
|
---|
1134 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1135 | author = {E. Soloway and J. Bonar and K. Ehrlich},
|
---|
1136 | title = {Cognitive Strategies and Looping Constructs: An Empirical Study},
|
---|
1137 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
1138 | month = nov,
|
---|
1139 | year = 1983,
|
---|
1140 | volume = 26,
|
---|
1141 | number = 11,
|
---|
1142 | pages = {853-860},
|
---|
1143 | }
|
---|
1144 |
|
---|
1145 | @book{sml:commentary,
|
---|
1146 | author = {Robin Milner and Mads Tofte},
|
---|
1147 | title = {Commentary on Standard {ML}},
|
---|
1148 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
1149 | address = {Cambridge},
|
---|
1150 | year = 1991
|
---|
1151 | }
|
---|
1152 |
|
---|
1153 | @article{Hyman66,
|
---|
1154 | keywords = {mutual exclusion, software solution, incorrect},
|
---|
1155 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1156 | author = {Harris Hyman},
|
---|
1157 | title = {Comments on a Problem in Concurrent Programming Control},
|
---|
1158 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
1159 | month = jan,
|
---|
1160 | year = 1966,
|
---|
1161 | volume = 9,
|
---|
1162 | number = 1,
|
---|
1163 | pages = {45},
|
---|
1164 | note = {Letter to the Editor}
|
---|
1165 | }
|
---|
1166 |
|
---|
1167 | @inproceedings{clos,
|
---|
1168 | keywords = {},
|
---|
1169 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1170 | author = {Linda G. DeMichiel and Richard P. Gabriel},
|
---|
1171 | title = {The Common Lisp Object System: An Overview},
|
---|
1172 | booktitle = {ECOOP '87. European Conference on Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
1173 | year = 1987,
|
---|
1174 | pages = {151-170},
|
---|
1175 | publisher = {Springer}
|
---|
1176 | }
|
---|
1177 |
|
---|
1178 | @book{CommonLisp,
|
---|
1179 | keywords = {common lisp},
|
---|
1180 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1181 | author = {Guy Steele},
|
---|
1182 | title = {COMMON LISP: The Language},
|
---|
1183 | publisher = {Digital Press},
|
---|
1184 | address = {New York},
|
---|
1185 | year = 1984
|
---|
1186 | }
|
---|
1187 |
|
---|
1188 | @article{CommonLoops,
|
---|
1189 | author = {D. Bobrow and K. Kahn and G. Kiczales and L. Masinter and M. Stefik and F. Zdybel},
|
---|
1190 | title = {CommonLoops: Merging Common Lisp and Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
1191 | address = {Portland, Oregon, U.S.A.},
|
---|
1192 | journal = {Proc. ACM Conf. on Object-Oriented Systems, Languages and Applications},
|
---|
1193 | year = 1986,
|
---|
1194 | month = sep,
|
---|
1195 | pages = {17-29},
|
---|
1196 | }
|
---|
1197 |
|
---|
1198 | @article{co-overview,
|
---|
1199 | keywords = {CommonObjects, implementation, encapsulation},
|
---|
1200 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1201 | author = {Alan Snyder},
|
---|
1202 | title = {CommonObjects: An Overview},
|
---|
1203 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
1204 | year = 1986,
|
---|
1205 | month = oct, volume = 21, number = 10, pages = {19-28},
|
---|
1206 | note = {Object Oriented Programming Workshop}
|
---|
1207 | }
|
---|
1208 |
|
---|
1209 | @article{CSP,
|
---|
1210 | keywords = {CSP, concurrency},
|
---|
1211 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1212 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare},
|
---|
1213 | title = {Communicating Sequential Processes},
|
---|
1214 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
1215 | month = aug,
|
---|
1216 | year = 1978,
|
---|
1217 | volume = 21,
|
---|
1218 | number = 8,
|
---|
1219 | pages = {666-677}
|
---|
1220 | }
|
---|
1221 |
|
---|
1222 | @book{Hoare85,
|
---|
1223 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare},
|
---|
1224 | title = {Communicating Sequential Processes},
|
---|
1225 | year = 1985,
|
---|
1226 | isbn = {0-13-153271-5},
|
---|
1227 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
1228 | address = {Upper Saddle River, NJ, USA},
|
---|
1229 | note = {\href{http://www.usingcsp.com/cspbook.pdf}{http://\-www.usingcsp.com/\-cspbook.pdf}},
|
---|
1230 | }
|
---|
1231 |
|
---|
1232 | @article{Hansen72a,
|
---|
1233 | keywords = {monitors, automatic signal},
|
---|
1234 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1235 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}},
|
---|
1236 | title = {A Comparison of Two Synchronizing Concepts},
|
---|
1237 | journal = acta,
|
---|
1238 | volume = 1,
|
---|
1239 | year = 1972,
|
---|
1240 | pages = {190-199},
|
---|
1241 | }
|
---|
1242 |
|
---|
1243 | @book{Aho06,
|
---|
1244 | author = {Alfred V. Aho and Monica S. Lam and Ravi Sethi and Jeffrey D. Ullman},
|
---|
1245 | title = {Compilers: Principles, Techniques, and Tools},
|
---|
1246 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
1247 | year = {2006},
|
---|
1248 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley Longman Publishing},
|
---|
1249 | address = {Boston, MA, USA},
|
---|
1250 | }
|
---|
1251 |
|
---|
1252 | @article{Bacon94,
|
---|
1253 | keywords = {parallelizing compiler},
|
---|
1254 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1255 | author = {David F. Bacon and Susan L. Graham and Oliver J. Sharp},
|
---|
1256 | title = {Compiler Transformations for High-Performance Com\-puting},
|
---|
1257 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
1258 | volume = 26,
|
---|
1259 | number = 4,
|
---|
1260 | month = dec,
|
---|
1261 | year = 1994,
|
---|
1262 | pages = {345-420},
|
---|
1263 | }
|
---|
1264 |
|
---|
1265 | @inproceedings{Berger01,
|
---|
1266 | author = {Emery D. Berger and Benjamin G. Zorn and Kathryn S. McKinley},
|
---|
1267 | title = {Composing High-Performance Memory Allocators},
|
---|
1268 | booktitle = {{SIGPLAN} Conference on Programming Language Design and Implementation},
|
---|
1269 | pages = {114-124},
|
---|
1270 | year = 2001,
|
---|
1271 | url = {http://citeseer.ist.psu.edu/berger01composing.html}
|
---|
1272 | }
|
---|
1273 |
|
---|
1274 | @article{Andrews83,
|
---|
1275 | keywords = {general concurrency},
|
---|
1276 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1277 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews and Fred B. Schneider},
|
---|
1278 | title = {Concepts and Notations for Concurrent Programming},
|
---|
1279 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
1280 | volume = 15,
|
---|
1281 | number = 1,
|
---|
1282 | month = mar,
|
---|
1283 | year = 1983,
|
---|
1284 | pages = {3-43},
|
---|
1285 | }
|
---|
1286 |
|
---|
1287 | @mastersthesis{Mok97,
|
---|
1288 | author = {Wing Yeung Russell Mok},
|
---|
1289 | title = {Concurrent Abnormal Event Handling Mechanisms},
|
---|
1290 | school = {University of Waterloo},
|
---|
1291 | year = 1997,
|
---|
1292 | month = sep,
|
---|
1293 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
1294 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/theses/MokThesis.pdf}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-theses/\-MokThesis.pdf}},
|
---|
1295 | }
|
---|
1296 |
|
---|
1297 | @article{Gehani86,
|
---|
1298 | keywords = {Concurrent programming, C, Distributed systems, rendezvous},
|
---|
1299 | contributer = {dgharriss@plg},
|
---|
1300 | author = {N. H. Gehani and W. D. Roome},
|
---|
1301 | title = {{Concurrent C}},
|
---|
1302 | journal = spe,
|
---|
1303 | volume = 16,
|
---|
1304 | number = 9,
|
---|
1305 | month = sep,
|
---|
1306 | year = 1986,
|
---|
1307 | pages = {821-844},
|
---|
1308 | abstract = {
|
---|
1309 | Our objective is to enhance C so that it can be used to write
|
---|
1310 | concurrent programs that can run efficiently on both single computers
|
---|
1311 | and multicomputers. Our concurrent programming extensions to C are
|
---|
1312 | based on the {\it rendezvous\/} concept. These extensions include
|
---|
1313 | mechanisms for the declaration and creation of processes, for process
|
---|
1314 | synchronization and interaction, for process termination and abortion.
|
---|
1315 | We give a rationale for our decisions and compare Concurrent C
|
---|
1316 | extensions with the concurrent programming facilities in Ada.
|
---|
1317 | Concurrent C has been implemented on the UNIX system running on a
|
---|
1318 | single processor. A distributed version of Concurrent C is being
|
---|
1319 | implemented.
|
---|
1320 | },
|
---|
1321 | comment = {
|
---|
1322 | Select with guarded and screened accepts. Typed processes.
|
---|
1323 | Process-valued expressions and process variables. Processes have
|
---|
1324 | execution priority: Create {\em process-type-name}(args) [with
|
---|
1325 | priority(p)],
|
---|
1326 | and the priority can be changed on the fly. Complicated guard/
|
---|
1327 | screen structure on accept: accept {\em transaction}(param names)
|
---|
1328 | [suchthat (exp)] [by (exp)] [compoundstatement]. Accepts cannot
|
---|
1329 | appear in functions! Can specify timeouts on transaction calls.
|
---|
1330 | Code examples: buffer process, dining philosophers, lock manager.
|
---|
1331 | Section on diffs between Concurrent C and Ada.
|
---|
1332 | }
|
---|
1333 | }
|
---|
1334 |
|
---|
1335 | @article{ConcurrentC++,
|
---|
1336 | keywords = {concurrency, C++},
|
---|
1337 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1338 | author = {N. H. Gehani and W. D. Roome},
|
---|
1339 | title = {Concurrent {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}: Concurrent Programming with Class(es)},
|
---|
1340 | journal = spe,
|
---|
1341 | month = dec,
|
---|
1342 | year = 1988,
|
---|
1343 | volume = 18,
|
---|
1344 | number = 12,
|
---|
1345 | pages = {1157-1177}
|
---|
1346 | }
|
---|
1347 |
|
---|
1348 | @article{Courtois71,
|
---|
1349 | keywords = {reader and writer, p and v},
|
---|
1350 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1351 | author = {P. J. Courtois and F. Heymans and D. L. Parnas},
|
---|
1352 | title = {Concurrent Control with Readers and Writers},
|
---|
1353 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
1354 | volume = 14,
|
---|
1355 | number = 10,
|
---|
1356 | month = oct,
|
---|
1357 | year = 1971,
|
---|
1358 | pages = {667-668},
|
---|
1359 | annote = {
|
---|
1360 | Many errors in the two solutions.
|
---|
1361 | }
|
---|
1362 | }
|
---|
1363 |
|
---|
1364 | @incollection{Reppy93,
|
---|
1365 | keywords = {ML, concurrency, continuation passing},
|
---|
1366 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1367 | author = {John H. Reppy},
|
---|
1368 | title = {Concurrent {ML}: Design, Application and Semantics},
|
---|
1369 | booktitle = {Functional Programming, Concurrency, Simulation and Automated Reasoning},
|
---|
1370 | editor = {P. E. Lauer},
|
---|
1371 | pages = {165-198},
|
---|
1372 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
1373 | address = {Berlin, DE},
|
---|
1374 | year = 1993,
|
---|
1375 | ISBN = {3-540-56883-2},
|
---|
1376 | abstract = {
|
---|
1377 | Concurrent ML (CML) is a high-level language for concurrent
|
---|
1378 | programming. It is an extension of Standard ML (SML) and is implemented
|
---|
1379 | on top of Standard ML of New Jersey (SML/NJ). CML is a practical
|
---|
1380 | language and is being used to build real systems. It demonstrates that
|
---|
1381 | one need not sacrifice high-level notation in order to have good
|
---|
1382 | performance. CML is also a well-defined language. In the tradition of
|
---|
1383 | SML, it has a formal semantics and its type-soundness has been
|
---|
1384 | proven.},
|
---|
1385 | note = {
|
---|
1386 | Proceedings of International Lecture Series 1991-92, McMaster
|
---|
1387 | UniversityLecture Notes in Computer Science 693.},
|
---|
1388 | }
|
---|
1389 |
|
---|
1390 | @article{BLASE-2,
|
---|
1391 | keywords = {concurrency, BLASE-2},
|
---|
1392 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1393 | author = {Piyush Mehrotra and John Van Rosendale},
|
---|
1394 | title = {Concurrent Object Access in BLASE~2},
|
---|
1395 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
1396 | volume = 24,
|
---|
1397 | number = 4,
|
---|
1398 | month = apr,
|
---|
1399 | year = 1989,
|
---|
1400 | pages = {40-42},
|
---|
1401 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN Workshop on Object-Based Concurrent Programming,
|
---|
1402 | Sept. 26--27, 1988, San Diego, California, U.S.A},
|
---|
1403 | }
|
---|
1404 |
|
---|
1405 | @techreport{Kafura88,
|
---|
1406 | keywords = {objects, concurrency},
|
---|
1407 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1408 | author = {Dennis Kafura},
|
---|
1409 | title = {Concurrent Object-Oriented Real-Time Systems Research},
|
---|
1410 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, Virginia Polytechnic},
|
---|
1411 | number = {TR 88-47},
|
---|
1412 | year = 1988
|
---|
1413 | }
|
---|
1414 |
|
---|
1415 | @article{Buhr92a,
|
---|
1416 | keywords = {C++, concurrency, light-weight process, shared memory},
|
---|
1417 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1418 | author = {P. A. Buhr and Glen Ditchfield and R. A. Stroobosscher and B. M. Younger and C. R. Zarnke},
|
---|
1419 | title = {$\mu${C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}: Concurrency in the Object-Oriented Language {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
1420 | journal = spe,
|
---|
1421 | volume = 22,
|
---|
1422 | number = 2,
|
---|
1423 | month = feb,
|
---|
1424 | year = 1992,
|
---|
1425 | pages = {137-172},
|
---|
1426 | }
|
---|
1427 |
|
---|
1428 | @techreport{uC++,
|
---|
1429 | keywords = {C++, concurrency, light-weight process, shared memory},
|
---|
1430 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1431 | author = {Peter A. Buhr},
|
---|
1432 | title = {$\mu${C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Annotated Reference Manual, Version 6.1.0},
|
---|
1433 | institution = {School of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
1434 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
1435 | month = jul,
|
---|
1436 | year = 2015,
|
---|
1437 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/~usystem/pub/uSystem/u++-6.1.0.sh}{\textsf{http://\-plg.\-uwaterloo.\-ca/\-$\sim$usystem/\-pub/\-uSystem/\-u++-6.1.0.sh}}},
|
---|
1438 | }
|
---|
1439 |
|
---|
1440 | @book{Burns93,
|
---|
1441 | keywords = {concurrency, Pascal},
|
---|
1442 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1443 | author = {Alan Burns and Geoff Davies},
|
---|
1444 | title = {Concurrent Programming},
|
---|
1445 | publisher = {Addison Wesley Longman},
|
---|
1446 | year = 1993,
|
---|
1447 | }
|
---|
1448 |
|
---|
1449 | @article{Hansen73a,
|
---|
1450 | keywords = {monitors},
|
---|
1451 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1452 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}},
|
---|
1453 | title = {Concurrent Programming Concepts},
|
---|
1454 | journal = spe,
|
---|
1455 | month = dec,
|
---|
1456 | year = 1973,
|
---|
1457 | volume = 5,
|
---|
1458 | number = 4,
|
---|
1459 | pages = {223-245},
|
---|
1460 | }
|
---|
1461 |
|
---|
1462 | @book{Lea97,
|
---|
1463 | keywords = {concurrency, Java},
|
---|
1464 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1465 | author = {Doug Lea},
|
---|
1466 | title = {Concurrent Programming in {J}ava: Design Principles and Patterns},
|
---|
1467 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
1468 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
1469 | year = 1997,
|
---|
1470 | edition = {1st},
|
---|
1471 | }
|
---|
1472 |
|
---|
1473 | @book{Hartley98,
|
---|
1474 | keywords = {concurrency, Java},
|
---|
1475 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1476 | author = {Stephen J. Hartley},
|
---|
1477 | title = {Concurrent Programming: The {J}ava Programming Language},
|
---|
1478 | publisher = {Oxford University Press},
|
---|
1479 | year = 1998,
|
---|
1480 | edition = {1st},
|
---|
1481 | }
|
---|
1482 |
|
---|
1483 | @book{Lea00,
|
---|
1484 | keywords = {concurrency, Java},
|
---|
1485 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1486 | author = {Doug Lea},
|
---|
1487 | title = {Concurrent Programming in {J}ava: Design Principles and Patterns},
|
---|
1488 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
1489 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
1490 | year = 2000,
|
---|
1491 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
1492 | }
|
---|
1493 |
|
---|
1494 | @book{ConcurrentC,
|
---|
1495 | keywords = {concurrency, C},
|
---|
1496 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1497 | author = {N. H. Gehani and W. D. Roome},
|
---|
1498 | title = {The {Concurrent C} Programming Language},
|
---|
1499 | publisher = {Silicon Press},
|
---|
1500 | address = {Summit},
|
---|
1501 | year = 1989,
|
---|
1502 | }
|
---|
1503 |
|
---|
1504 | @book{Andrews91:book,
|
---|
1505 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
1506 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1507 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews},
|
---|
1508 | title = {Concurrent Programming: Principles and Practice},
|
---|
1509 | publisher = {Benjamin/Cummings Publish\-ing},
|
---|
1510 | address = {Redwood City},
|
---|
1511 | year = 1991,
|
---|
1512 | }
|
---|
1513 |
|
---|
1514 | @article{Buhr05a,
|
---|
1515 | keywords = {concurrency, myths},
|
---|
1516 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1517 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Ashif S. Harji},
|
---|
1518 | title = {Concurrent Urban Legends},
|
---|
1519 | journal = ccpe,
|
---|
1520 | month = aug,
|
---|
1521 | year = 2005,
|
---|
1522 | volume = 17,
|
---|
1523 | number = 9,
|
---|
1524 | pages = {1133-1172},
|
---|
1525 | }
|
---|
1526 |
|
---|
1527 | @techreport{Buhr90,
|
---|
1528 | keywords = {objects, concurrency},
|
---|
1529 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1530 | author = {P. A. Buhr and G. J. Ditchfield and B. M. Younger and C. R. Zarnke},
|
---|
1531 | title = {Concurrency in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
1532 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
1533 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
1534 | number = {CS-90-18},
|
---|
1535 | month = may,
|
---|
1536 | year = 1990
|
---|
1537 | }
|
---|
1538 |
|
---|
1539 | @book{Burns98,
|
---|
1540 | keywords = {concurrency, Ada},
|
---|
1541 | author = {Alan Burns and Andy Wellings},
|
---|
1542 | title = {Concurrency in {Ada}},
|
---|
1543 | publisher = {Cambridge University Press},
|
---|
1544 | year = 1998,
|
---|
1545 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
1546 | }
|
---|
1547 |
|
---|
1548 | @book{Bernstein93,
|
---|
1549 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
1550 | author = {Arthur J. Bernstein and Philip M. Lewis},
|
---|
1551 | title = {Concurrency in Programming and Database Systems},
|
---|
1552 | publisher = {Jones and Bartlett},
|
---|
1553 | year = 1993,
|
---|
1554 | }
|
---|
1555 |
|
---|
1556 | @inproceedings{Pitman01,
|
---|
1557 | keywords = {LISP, exception handling},
|
---|
1558 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1559 | author = {Kent M. Pitman},
|
---|
1560 | title = {Condition Handling in the Lisp Language Family},
|
---|
1561 | booktitle = {Exception Handling},
|
---|
1562 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
1563 | volume = 2022,
|
---|
1564 | series = {LNCS},
|
---|
1565 | year = 2001,
|
---|
1566 | pages = {39-59}
|
---|
1567 | }
|
---|
1568 |
|
---|
1569 | @inbook{enhancement,
|
---|
1570 | keywords = {bounded polymorphism, Comandos},
|
---|
1571 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1572 | author = {Chris Horn},
|
---|
1573 | title = {Conformace, Genericity, Inheritance and Enhancement},
|
---|
1574 | pages = {223-233},
|
---|
1575 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
1576 | year = 1987,
|
---|
1577 | volume = 276,
|
---|
1578 | series = "Lecture Notes in Computer Science",
|
---|
1579 | note = "ECOOP '87 European Conference on Object-Oriented Programming",
|
---|
1580 | summary = {
|
---|
1581 | Considers effect of conformance on Meyer's conclusions in
|
---|
1582 | \cite{polymorphism}.
|
---|
1583 |
|
---|
1584 | Implementing a swap function as a member of a type {\cd Swappable}
|
---|
1585 | with {\cd in out Top} parameters doesn't work, because conformance
|
---|
1586 | requires arguments to be of type {\cd Top}.
|
---|
1587 |
|
---|
1588 | An enhancive type has a type parameter, bounded by some type, and
|
---|
1589 | defines members. Types conforming to the bound can be passed as
|
---|
1590 | arguments to create types with the extra members. The signature of
|
---|
1591 | the enhanced type is based on the signature of the argument, not the
|
---|
1592 | bound, as if enhancive types were macros. Hence enhanced types do not
|
---|
1593 | necessarily conform to each other. Types conforming to the bound
|
---|
1594 | conform to enhanced types, which allows new functions to be applied
|
---|
1595 | to old types.
|
---|
1596 |
|
---|
1597 | Enhancive types are not generic types. If the argument is omitted,
|
---|
1598 | the bound is used as a default. Assignment of enhanced types to
|
---|
1599 | default-enhanced types is allowed (enhanced types conform to the
|
---|
1600 | default-enhanced type). This is (probably) statically type-safe,
|
---|
1601 | because arguments must conform to the bound, and the new members
|
---|
1602 | only use operations defined for the bound.
|
---|
1603 |
|
---|
1604 | With facilities for member renaming and deletion, enhancive types
|
---|
1605 | provide the equivalent of constrained generic types.
|
---|
1606 | }
|
---|
1607 | }
|
---|
1608 |
|
---|
1609 | @phdthesis{Ditchfield92,
|
---|
1610 | keywords = {C, parametric polymorphism, overloading},
|
---|
1611 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1612 | author = {Glen Jeffrey Ditchfield},
|
---|
1613 | title = {Contextual Polymorphism},
|
---|
1614 | school = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
1615 | year = 1992,
|
---|
1616 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
1617 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/theses/DitchfieldThesis.pdf}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-theses/\-DitchfieldThesis.pdf}}
|
---|
1618 | }
|
---|
1619 |
|
---|
1620 | @inproceedings{frameworks:HHG90,
|
---|
1621 | keywords = {formal},
|
---|
1622 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1623 | author = {Richard Helm and Ian M. Holland and Dipayan Gangopadhyay},
|
---|
1624 | title = {Contracts: Specifying Behavioural Compositions in Cbject-Oriented Systems},
|
---|
1625 | booktitle = {Proceedings of ACM Symposium on Object-Oriented Programming: Systems, Languages and Applications},
|
---|
1626 | year = 1990,
|
---|
1627 | pages = {169-180},
|
---|
1628 | }
|
---|
1629 |
|
---|
1630 | @article{Wand80,
|
---|
1631 | keywords = {concurrency, continuation},
|
---|
1632 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1633 | author = {Mitchell Wand},
|
---|
1634 | title = {Continuation-Based Multiprocessing},
|
---|
1635 | publisher = {The Lisp Conference},
|
---|
1636 | journal = {Conference Record of the 1980 Lisp Conference},
|
---|
1637 | pages = {19-28},
|
---|
1638 | year = 1980,
|
---|
1639 | }
|
---|
1640 |
|
---|
1641 | @article{Hieb90,
|
---|
1642 | keywords = {continuations, concurrency},
|
---|
1643 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1644 | author = {Robert Hieb and R. Kent Dybvig},
|
---|
1645 | title = {Continuations and Concurrency},
|
---|
1646 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
1647 | volume = 25,
|
---|
1648 | number = 3,
|
---|
1649 | month = mar,
|
---|
1650 | year = 1990,
|
---|
1651 | pages = {128-136},
|
---|
1652 | note = {Proceedings of the Second ACM SIGPLAN Symposium on Principles \& Practise of Parallel Programming,
|
---|
1653 | March. 14--16, 1990, Seattle, Washington, U.S.A},
|
---|
1654 | }
|
---|
1655 |
|
---|
1656 | @inproceedings{Haynes84,
|
---|
1657 | keywords = {continuations, coroutines, Scheme},
|
---|
1658 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1659 | author = {Christopher T. Haynes and Daniel P. Friedman and Mitchell Wand},
|
---|
1660 | title = {Continuations and Coroutines},
|
---|
1661 | booktitle = {Conference Record of the 1984 {ACM} Symposium on Lisp and Functional Programming},
|
---|
1662 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
1663 | month = aug,
|
---|
1664 | year = 1984,
|
---|
1665 | pages = {293-298},
|
---|
1666 | abstract = {
|
---|
1667 | The power of first class continuations is demonstrated by implementing
|
---|
1668 | a variety of coroutine mechanisms using only continuations and
|
---|
1669 | functional abstraction. The importance of general abstraction
|
---|
1670 | mechanisms such as continuations is discussed.},
|
---|
1671 | }
|
---|
1672 |
|
---|
1673 | @inproceedings{Zahn74,
|
---|
1674 | keywords = {goto, structured programming},
|
---|
1675 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1676 | author = {C. T. Zahn},
|
---|
1677 | title = {Control Statement for Natural Top-down Structured Programming},
|
---|
1678 | booktitle = {Symposium on Programming Languages},
|
---|
1679 | address = {Paris, France},
|
---|
1680 | year = 1974,
|
---|
1681 | }
|
---|
1682 |
|
---|
1683 | @unpublished{Ditchfield:conversions,
|
---|
1684 | contributer = {a3moss@uwaterloo.ca},
|
---|
1685 | author = {Glen Ditchfield},
|
---|
1686 | title = {Conversions for {Cforall}},
|
---|
1687 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/~cforall/Conversions/index.html}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-\textasciitilde cforall/\-Conversions/\-index.html}},
|
---|
1688 | month = {Nov},
|
---|
1689 | year = {2002},
|
---|
1690 | urldate = {28 July 2016},
|
---|
1691 | }
|
---|
1692 |
|
---|
1693 | @techreport{Dijkstra65,
|
---|
1694 | keywords = {concurrency, Dekker's algorithm, semaphores},
|
---|
1695 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1696 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
1697 | title = {Cooperating Sequential Processes},
|
---|
1698 | institution = {Technological University},
|
---|
1699 | address = {Eindhoven, Netherlands},
|
---|
1700 | year = 1965,
|
---|
1701 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{Genuys68} pp. 43--112.}
|
---|
1702 | }
|
---|
1703 |
|
---|
1704 | @book{Marlin80,
|
---|
1705 | keywords = {coroutines},
|
---|
1706 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1707 | author = {Christopher D. Marlin},
|
---|
1708 | title = {Coroutines: A Programming Methodology, a Language Design and an Implementation},
|
---|
1709 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
1710 | address = {New York},
|
---|
1711 | year = 1980,
|
---|
1712 | volume = 95,
|
---|
1713 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science, Ed. by G. Goos and J. Hartmanis}
|
---|
1714 | }
|
---|
1715 |
|
---|
1716 | @article{Wang71,
|
---|
1717 | keywords = {coroutines},
|
---|
1718 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1719 | author = {Arne Wang and Ole-Johan Dahl},
|
---|
1720 | title = {Coroutine Sequencing in a Block Structured Environment},
|
---|
1721 | journal = "BIT",
|
---|
1722 | volume = 11,
|
---|
1723 | month = nov,
|
---|
1724 | year = 1971,
|
---|
1725 | pages = {425-449},
|
---|
1726 | }
|
---|
1727 |
|
---|
1728 | @article{Castagna95,
|
---|
1729 | keywords = {type-systems, covariance, contravariance},
|
---|
1730 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1731 | author = {Giuseppe Castagna},
|
---|
1732 | title = {Covariance and Contravariance : Conflict without a Cause},
|
---|
1733 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
1734 | volume = 17,
|
---|
1735 | number = 3,
|
---|
1736 | month = may,
|
---|
1737 | year = 1995,
|
---|
1738 | pages = {341-447},
|
---|
1739 | }
|
---|
1740 |
|
---|
1741 | @book{Fischer88,
|
---|
1742 | keywords = {compiler construction},
|
---|
1743 | author = {Charles N. Fischer and Richard J. {LeBlanc, Jr.}},
|
---|
1744 | title = {Crafting a Compiler},
|
---|
1745 | publisher = {Benjamin Cummings},
|
---|
1746 | year = 1991,
|
---|
1747 | }
|
---|
1748 |
|
---|
1749 | @article{Moore75,
|
---|
1750 | keywords = {approximation methods, integrated circuits},
|
---|
1751 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1752 | author = {Gordon E. Moore},
|
---|
1753 | title = {Progress in Digital Integrated Electronics},
|
---|
1754 | journal = {Technical Digest, International Electron Devices Meeting, IEEE},
|
---|
1755 | year = 1975,
|
---|
1756 | pages = {11-13},
|
---|
1757 | }
|
---|
1758 |
|
---|
1759 | @inproceedings{Jim02,
|
---|
1760 | keywords = {C dialect, parametric polymorphic, safe memory allocation},
|
---|
1761 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1762 | author = {Trevor Jim and Greg Morrisett and Dan Grossman and Michael Hicks and James Cheney and and Yanling Wang},
|
---|
1763 | title = {{C}yclone: A Safe Dialect of {C}},
|
---|
1764 | booktitle = {USENIX Annual Technical Conference},
|
---|
1765 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
1766 | address = {Monterey, California, U.S.A.},
|
---|
1767 | month = jun,
|
---|
1768 | year = 2002,
|
---|
1769 | pages = {275-288},
|
---|
1770 | }
|
---|
1771 |
|
---|
1772 | % D
|
---|
1773 |
|
---|
1774 | @manual{D,
|
---|
1775 | keywords = {D programming language},
|
---|
1776 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1777 | title = {{D} Programming Language},
|
---|
1778 | author = {Walter Bright and Andrei Alexandrescu},
|
---|
1779 | organization= {Digital Mars},
|
---|
1780 | year = 2016,
|
---|
1781 | note = {\href{http://dlang.org/spec/spec.html}{http://\-dlang.org/\-spec/\-spec.html}},
|
---|
1782 | }
|
---|
1783 |
|
---|
1784 | @techreport{Cui90,
|
---|
1785 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
1786 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1787 | author = {Qian Cui},
|
---|
1788 | title = {Data-Oriented Exception Handling},
|
---|
1789 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Maryland},
|
---|
1790 | address = {College Park, Maryland, U.S.A., 20742},
|
---|
1791 | number = {CS-TR-2384},
|
---|
1792 | month = jan,
|
---|
1793 | year = 1990,
|
---|
1794 | }
|
---|
1795 |
|
---|
1796 | @article{Cui92,
|
---|
1797 | contributer = {rkrische@plg},
|
---|
1798 | author = {Qian Cui and John Gannon},
|
---|
1799 | title = {Data-oriented Exception Handling},
|
---|
1800 | journal = {IEEE Transactions on Software Engineering},
|
---|
1801 | month = may,
|
---|
1802 | year = 1992,
|
---|
1803 | volume = 18,
|
---|
1804 | number = 5,
|
---|
1805 | pages = {393-401},
|
---|
1806 | }
|
---|
1807 |
|
---|
1808 | @manual{SIMULA87,
|
---|
1809 | keywords = {Simula standard},
|
---|
1810 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1811 | title = {Databehandling -- Programspr{\aa}k -- {SIMULA}},
|
---|
1812 | organization= {Standardiseringskommissionen i Sverige},
|
---|
1813 | note = {Svensk Standard SS 63 61 14},
|
---|
1814 | year = 1987,
|
---|
1815 | abstract = {
|
---|
1816 | Standard for the programming language SIMULA. Written in English.
|
---|
1817 | }
|
---|
1818 | }
|
---|
1819 |
|
---|
1820 | @article{Liskov75,
|
---|
1821 | keywords = {abstract data types, encapsulation, verification},
|
---|
1822 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1823 | author = {Barbara H. Liskov},
|
---|
1824 | title = {Data Types and Program Correctness},
|
---|
1825 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
1826 | year = 1975,
|
---|
1827 | month = jul,
|
---|
1828 | volume = 10,
|
---|
1829 | number = 7,
|
---|
1830 | pages = {16-17},
|
---|
1831 | summary = {
|
---|
1832 | Type definitions should contain the implementation of the type and
|
---|
1833 | its operations. The grouping makes programs simpler and more
|
---|
1834 | understandable. Encapsulating the definition aids verification and
|
---|
1835 | forces a precise specification of the interface.
|
---|
1836 | }
|
---|
1837 | }
|
---|
1838 |
|
---|
1839 | @article{dtav,
|
---|
1840 | keywords = {Russell, types},
|
---|
1841 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1842 | author = {James Donahue and Alan Demers},
|
---|
1843 | title = {Data Types are Values},
|
---|
1844 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
1845 | month = jul,
|
---|
1846 | year = 1985,
|
---|
1847 | volume = 7,
|
---|
1848 | number = 3,
|
---|
1849 | pages = {426-445},
|
---|
1850 | comment = {
|
---|
1851 | Data types are sets of operations providing interpretations of
|
---|
1852 | values from a meaningless, typeless universal value space. Types
|
---|
1853 | and operations are also contained in this value space.
|
---|
1854 |
|
---|
1855 | Functions returning types replace generic types.
|
---|
1856 |
|
---|
1857 | Polymorphic functions have type parameters. Evaluation is not
|
---|
1858 | macro expansion:
|
---|
1859 | \begin{verbatim}
|
---|
1860 | R == func [n:val integer; T:type[]] val integer
|
---|
1861 | {if n > 0 => r[n-1, Array[1,10,T]] # n <= 0 => 17 fi}
|
---|
1862 | \end{verbatim}
|
---|
1863 | }
|
---|
1864 | }
|
---|
1865 |
|
---|
1866 | @article{Holt72,
|
---|
1867 | keywords = {concurrency, deadlock},
|
---|
1868 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1869 | author = {Richard C. Holt},
|
---|
1870 | title = {Some Deadlock Properties of Computer Systems},
|
---|
1871 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
1872 | volume = 4,
|
---|
1873 | number = 3,
|
---|
1874 | month = sep,
|
---|
1875 | year = 1972,
|
---|
1876 | pages = {179-196},
|
---|
1877 | }
|
---|
1878 |
|
---|
1879 | @misc{debug-malloc,
|
---|
1880 | keywords = {memory allocation debugger},
|
---|
1881 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1882 | author = {Conor P. Cahill},
|
---|
1883 | title = {debug\_malloc},
|
---|
1884 | howpublished= {comp.sources.unix, volume 22, issue 112},
|
---|
1885 | abstract = {
|
---|
1886 | This package is a collection of routines which are a drop-in
|
---|
1887 | replacement for the malloc(3), memory(3), string(3), and bstring(3)
|
---|
1888 | library functions.
|
---|
1889 | }
|
---|
1890 | }
|
---|
1891 |
|
---|
1892 | @book{sml,
|
---|
1893 | keywords = {},
|
---|
1894 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1895 | author = {Robin Milner and Mads Tofte and Robert Harper},
|
---|
1896 | title = {The Definition of Standard {ML}},
|
---|
1897 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
1898 | address = {Cambridge},
|
---|
1899 | year = 1990
|
---|
1900 | }
|
---|
1901 |
|
---|
1902 | @techreport{sml:old,
|
---|
1903 | keywords = {},
|
---|
1904 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1905 | author = {Robert Harper and Robin Milner and Mads Tofte},
|
---|
1906 | title = {The Definition of Standard {ML}, Version 2},
|
---|
1907 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Edinburgh},
|
---|
1908 | year = 1988,
|
---|
1909 | address = {The King's Buildings, Edinburgh EH9 3JZ},
|
---|
1910 | type = {LFCS Report Series}, month = aug, number = {ECS-LFCS-88-62}
|
---|
1911 | }
|
---|
1912 |
|
---|
1913 | @inproceedings{Reynolds72,
|
---|
1914 | keywords = {continuation},
|
---|
1915 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1916 | author = {John Reynolds},
|
---|
1917 | title = {Definitional Interpreters for Higher Order Programming Languages},
|
---|
1918 | booktitle = {ACM Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
1919 | organization= {ACM},
|
---|
1920 | year = 1972,
|
---|
1921 | pages = {717-740}
|
---|
1922 | }
|
---|
1923 |
|
---|
1924 | @article{Buhr16,
|
---|
1925 | keywords = {Dekker's algorithm, software solution, mutual exclusion, performance experiment},
|
---|
1926 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and David Dice and Wim H. Hesselink},
|
---|
1927 | title = {Dekker's Mutual Exclusion Algorithm Made RW-Safe},
|
---|
1928 | journal = ccpe,
|
---|
1929 | volume = 28,
|
---|
1930 | number = 1,
|
---|
1931 | pages = {144-165},
|
---|
1932 | month = jan,
|
---|
1933 | year = 2016,
|
---|
1934 | }
|
---|
1935 |
|
---|
1936 | @misc{steelman,
|
---|
1937 | keywords = {Ada},
|
---|
1938 | contributer = {gjditchfied@plg},
|
---|
1939 | author = {High Order Language Working Group},
|
---|
1940 | title = {Department of Defense Requirements for High Order Computer Programming Languages},
|
---|
1941 | month = jun, year = 1978,
|
---|
1942 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{pldesign}.}
|
---|
1943 | }
|
---|
1944 |
|
---|
1945 | @incollection{Tsay98,
|
---|
1946 | keywords = {local spins, mutual exclusion, read/write atomicity, refinement, scalability},
|
---|
1947 | author = {Yih-Kuen Tsay},
|
---|
1948 | title = {Deriving a scalable algorithm for mutual exclusion},
|
---|
1949 | booktitle = {Distributed Computing},
|
---|
1950 | editor = {Shay Kutten},
|
---|
1951 | volume = {1499},
|
---|
1952 | series = {LNCS},
|
---|
1953 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
1954 | address = {Berlin Heidelberg},
|
---|
1955 | year = {1998},
|
---|
1956 | pages = {393-407},
|
---|
1957 | }
|
---|
1958 |
|
---|
1959 | @article{Conway63,
|
---|
1960 | keywords = {coroutine, original},
|
---|
1961 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
1962 | author = {Melvin E. Conway},
|
---|
1963 | title = {Design of a Separable Transition-Diagram Compiler},
|
---|
1964 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
1965 | month = jul,
|
---|
1966 | year = 1963,
|
---|
1967 | volume = 6,
|
---|
1968 | number = 7,
|
---|
1969 | pages = {396-408},
|
---|
1970 | }
|
---|
1971 |
|
---|
1972 | @book{Stroustrup94,
|
---|
1973 | keywords = {C++},
|
---|
1974 | contributor = {wyrmok@plg},
|
---|
1975 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
1976 | title = {The Design and Evolution of {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
1977 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
1978 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
1979 | year = 1994
|
---|
1980 | }
|
---|
1981 |
|
---|
1982 | @inproceedings{st:concurrent,
|
---|
1983 | keywords = {concurrency, Smalltalk, futures},
|
---|
1984 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
1985 | author = {Yasuhiko Yokote and Mario Tokoro},
|
---|
1986 | title = {The Design and Implementation of {ConcurrentSmalltalk}},
|
---|
1987 | crossref = "OOPSLA86",
|
---|
1988 | pages = {331-340},
|
---|
1989 | comment = {
|
---|
1990 | Objects are ordinary Smalltalk objects or ``atomic'' objects, which
|
---|
1991 | process messages one at a time in FIFO order. Asynchronous method
|
---|
1992 | calls are made by appending ``\&'' at the call site. The sender does
|
---|
1993 | not wait for a reply. If the method returns a value, it
|
---|
1994 | (immediately?) returns a CBox object, which is like a future. The
|
---|
1995 | sender can send the ``receive'' message to the CBox, which blocks
|
---|
1996 | until the CBox contains a value.
|
---|
1997 |
|
---|
1998 | A method can execute the ``\verb|^|'' statement to return an object
|
---|
1999 | and terminate, or it can execute ``\verb|^^|'' to return an object
|
---|
2000 | and continue execution. If ``\verb|^^foo|'' is executed after
|
---|
2001 | ``\verb|^^bar|'', foo is discarded, since bar has already been
|
---|
2002 | returned.
|
---|
2003 |
|
---|
2004 | The article does not say whether asynchronous messages can be sent
|
---|
2005 | to ordinary objects, or whether ordinary messages can be sent to
|
---|
2006 | atomic objects.
|
---|
2007 | }
|
---|
2008 | }
|
---|
2009 |
|
---|
2010 | @inproceedings{Ichbiah83,
|
---|
2011 | keywords = {Ada, packages, generics},
|
---|
2012 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2013 | author = {Jean D. Ichbiah},
|
---|
2014 | title = {On the Design of {Ada}},
|
---|
2015 | booktitle = {Information Processing 83},
|
---|
2016 | year = 1983,
|
---|
2017 | month = sep, pages = {1-10},
|
---|
2018 | editor = {R. E. A. Mason},
|
---|
2019 | organization= {IFIP},
|
---|
2020 | publisher = {North-Holland},
|
---|
2021 | summary = {
|
---|
2022 | Packages group related declarations or subprograms, and encapsulate
|
---|
2023 | data types. Separate interfaces and bodies promotes information
|
---|
2024 | hiding by removing the need to scan the body, allows the body to be
|
---|
2025 | confidential, and provides a better specification of the contract
|
---|
2026 | between client and implementor. Generics are an efficient way to
|
---|
2027 | factor out parts of similar definitions.
|
---|
2028 | }
|
---|
2029 | }
|
---|
2030 |
|
---|
2031 | @book{Motet96,
|
---|
2032 | keywords = {Ada, exception handling},
|
---|
2033 | contributer = {wyrmok@plg},
|
---|
2034 | author = {G. Motet and A. Mapinard and J. C. Geoffroy},
|
---|
2035 | title = {Design of Dependable {A}da Software},
|
---|
2036 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
2037 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
2038 | year = 1996,
|
---|
2039 | }
|
---|
2040 |
|
---|
2041 | @article{Richardson93,
|
---|
2042 | keywords = {C++, persistence, database},
|
---|
2043 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2044 | author = {Joel E. Richardson and Michael J. Carey and Daniel T. Schuh},
|
---|
2045 | title = {The Design of the {E} Programming Language},
|
---|
2046 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
2047 | month = jul,
|
---|
2048 | year = 1993,
|
---|
2049 | volume = 15,
|
---|
2050 | number = 3,
|
---|
2051 | pages = {494-534},
|
---|
2052 | }
|
---|
2053 |
|
---|
2054 | @article{Hansen81b,
|
---|
2055 | keywords = {concurrency, monitor, critical region},
|
---|
2056 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2057 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}},
|
---|
2058 | title = {The Design of {E}dison},
|
---|
2059 | journal = spe,
|
---|
2060 | volume = 11,
|
---|
2061 | number = 4,
|
---|
2062 | month = apr,
|
---|
2063 | year = 1981,
|
---|
2064 | pages = {363-396},
|
---|
2065 | }
|
---|
2066 |
|
---|
2067 | @book{Gamma95,
|
---|
2068 | keywords = {design patterns},
|
---|
2069 | author = {Erich Gamma and Richard Helm and Ralph Johnson and John Vlissides},
|
---|
2070 | title = {Design Patterns: Elements of Reusable Object-Oriented Software},
|
---|
2071 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
2072 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
2073 | year = 1995,
|
---|
2074 | series = {Professional Computing Series},
|
---|
2075 | }
|
---|
2076 |
|
---|
2077 | @inproceedings{Wirth74,
|
---|
2078 | keywords = {},
|
---|
2079 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2080 | author = {Niklaus Wirth},
|
---|
2081 | title = {On the Design of Programming Languages},
|
---|
2082 | booktitle = {Information Processing 74},
|
---|
2083 | year = 1974,
|
---|
2084 | pages = {386-393},
|
---|
2085 | publisher = {North Holland Publishing Company},
|
---|
2086 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{pldesign}.}
|
---|
2087 | }
|
---|
2088 |
|
---|
2089 | @techreport{forceone,
|
---|
2090 | keywords = {Parametric polymorphism, ForceOne},
|
---|
2091 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2092 | author = {Andrew K. Wright},
|
---|
2093 | title = {Design of the Programming Language {ForceOne}},
|
---|
2094 | institution = {University of Waterloo},
|
---|
2095 | month = feb, year = 1987,
|
---|
2096 | number = {CS-87-10}
|
---|
2097 | }
|
---|
2098 |
|
---|
2099 | @techreport{x-2,
|
---|
2100 | keywords = {object based},
|
---|
2101 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2102 | author = {David W. Sandberg},
|
---|
2103 | title = {The Design of the Programming Language {X-2}},
|
---|
2104 | institution = {Oregon State University},
|
---|
2105 | year = 1985,
|
---|
2106 | address = {Department of Computer Science, Corvallis, Oregon, 97331},
|
---|
2107 | number = {85-60-1}
|
---|
2108 | }
|
---|
2109 |
|
---|
2110 | @article{design,
|
---|
2111 | keywords = {Smalltalk, designing classes},
|
---|
2112 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2113 | author = {Ralph E. Johnson and Brian Foote},
|
---|
2114 | title = {Designing Reusable Classes},
|
---|
2115 | journal = joop,
|
---|
2116 | year = 1988,
|
---|
2117 | volume = 1, number = 2, pages = {22-35},
|
---|
2118 | comment = {
|
---|
2119 | Abstract classes represent standard protocols. ``It is better to
|
---|
2120 | inherit from an abstract class than from a concrete class''.
|
---|
2121 | Frameworks are collections of related abstract classes. Successful
|
---|
2122 | abstractions are discovered, not designed.
|
---|
2123 |
|
---|
2124 | Protocols: ``If an operation X is implemented by performing a
|
---|
2125 | similar operation on the components of the receiver, then that
|
---|
2126 | operation should also be named X''. Eliminate case analysis by
|
---|
2127 | creating classes with the same operations. Create classes to
|
---|
2128 | represent bundles of parameters. Shrink methods larger than 30
|
---|
2129 | lines.
|
---|
2130 |
|
---|
2131 | Hierarchies should be deep and narrow. Subclasses should be
|
---|
2132 | specializations.
|
---|
2133 |
|
---|
2134 | Frameworks: split large classes. Factor implementation differences
|
---|
2135 | into subcomponents. Separate methods that do not share instance
|
---|
2136 | variables into components that reflect the different views of the
|
---|
2137 | object. Send messages to components, not self. Reduce implicit
|
---|
2138 | parameter passing through instance variables.
|
---|
2139 | }
|
---|
2140 | }
|
---|
2141 |
|
---|
2142 | @article{dim:c++,
|
---|
2143 | keywords = {Dimensional Analysis, C++},
|
---|
2144 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2145 | author = {Robert F. Cmelic and Narain Gehani},
|
---|
2146 | title = {Dimensional Analysis with {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
2147 | journal = {IEEE Software},
|
---|
2148 | month = may, year = 1988,
|
---|
2149 | volume = 5, number = 3, pages = {21-29}
|
---|
2150 | }
|
---|
2151 |
|
---|
2152 | @article{Wegner87,
|
---|
2153 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2154 | author = {Peter Wegner},
|
---|
2155 | title = {Dimensions of Object--Based Language Design},
|
---|
2156 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
2157 | volume = 22,
|
---|
2158 | number = 12,
|
---|
2159 | month = dec,
|
---|
2160 | year = 1987,
|
---|
2161 | pages = {168-182},
|
---|
2162 | note = {Proceedings of the OOPSLA'87 Conference, Oct. 4--8, 1987, Orlando, Florida},
|
---|
2163 | }
|
---|
2164 |
|
---|
2165 | @book{Dijkstra76,
|
---|
2166 | keywords = {concurrent assignment},
|
---|
2167 | author = {E. W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
2168 | title = {A Discipline of Programming},
|
---|
2169 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
2170 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
2171 | year = 1976,
|
---|
2172 | }
|
---|
2173 |
|
---|
2174 | @book{Lynch96,
|
---|
2175 | keywords = {distributed algorithms},
|
---|
2176 | author = {Nancy A. Lynch},
|
---|
2177 | title = {Distributed Algorithms},
|
---|
2178 | publisher = {Morgan Kaufmann},
|
---|
2179 | year = 1996,
|
---|
2180 | }
|
---|
2181 |
|
---|
2182 | @book{Tanenbaum02,
|
---|
2183 | keywords = {distributed programming},
|
---|
2184 | author = {Andrew S. Tanenbaum and Maarten van Steen},
|
---|
2185 | title = {Distributed Systems: Principles and Paradigms},
|
---|
2186 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
2187 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
2188 | year = 2002,
|
---|
2189 | }
|
---|
2190 |
|
---|
2191 | @inproceedings{Cargill90,
|
---|
2192 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
2193 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2194 | author = {Tom A. Cargill},
|
---|
2195 | title = {Does {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Really Need Multiple Inheritance?},
|
---|
2196 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
2197 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
2198 | address = {San Francisco, California, U.S.A.},
|
---|
2199 | month = apr,
|
---|
2200 | year = 1990,
|
---|
2201 | pages = {315-323}
|
---|
2202 | }
|
---|
2203 |
|
---|
2204 | @unpublished{Duff83,
|
---|
2205 | keywords = {C, switch statement, control flow},
|
---|
2206 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2207 | author = {Tom Duff},
|
---|
2208 | title = {Duff's Device},
|
---|
2209 | month = nov,
|
---|
2210 | year = 1983,
|
---|
2211 | note = {\href{http://www.lysator.liu.se/c/duffs-device.html}{http://\-www.lysator.liu.se/\-c/\-duffs-device.html}}
|
---|
2212 | }
|
---|
2213 |
|
---|
2214 | @manual{dwarf2,
|
---|
2215 | keywords = {Debugging DWARF2 specification},
|
---|
2216 | contributer = {rkrische@plg},
|
---|
2217 | title = {DWARF Debugging Information Format},
|
---|
2218 | organization= {Unix International Programming Languages SIG},
|
---|
2219 | publisher = {Unix International},
|
---|
2220 | address = {Waterview Corporate Center, 20 Waterview Boulevard, Parsippany, NJ 07054},
|
---|
2221 | year = {1993}
|
---|
2222 | }
|
---|
2223 |
|
---|
2224 | @article{classicada,
|
---|
2225 | keywords = {Classic Ada},
|
---|
2226 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2227 | author = {Cameron M. Donaldson},
|
---|
2228 | title = {Dynamic Binding and Inheritance in an Object-Oriented {Ada} Design},
|
---|
2229 | journal = {Journal of Pascal, {Ada} \& Modula-2},
|
---|
2230 | year = 1990,
|
---|
2231 | month = {jul/aug}, volume = 9, number = 4, pages = {12-19},
|
---|
2232 | comment = {
|
---|
2233 | Classes are like packages: they can contain subprograms, types,
|
---|
2234 | variables, generic instantiations, and exceptions. They can also
|
---|
2235 | contain class methods, instance methods, and instance variables,
|
---|
2236 | and define creation and initialization subprograms or methods for
|
---|
2237 | instances. Single inheritance provides inheritance of
|
---|
2238 | implementations. Dynamic binding is done with a {\em send}
|
---|
2239 | statement that invokes a class or instance method. A preprocessor
|
---|
2240 | converts Classic Ada to normal Ada.
|
---|
2241 | }
|
---|
2242 | }
|
---|
2243 |
|
---|
2244 | @article{Costanza03,
|
---|
2245 | keywords = {dynamic call},
|
---|
2246 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2247 | author = {Pascal Costanza},
|
---|
2248 | title = {Dynamic Scoped Functions as the Essence of {AOP}},
|
---|
2249 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
2250 | volume = 38,
|
---|
2251 | number = 8,
|
---|
2252 | month = aug,
|
---|
2253 | year = 2003,
|
---|
2254 | pages = {29-35},
|
---|
2255 | }
|
---|
2256 |
|
---|
2257 | % E
|
---|
2258 |
|
---|
2259 | @inproceedings{Wegbreit71,
|
---|
2260 | keywords = {polymorphism},
|
---|
2261 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2262 | author = {B. Wegbreit},
|
---|
2263 | title = {The ECL Programming System},
|
---|
2264 | booktitle = {Proceedings of AFIPS 1971 FJCC},
|
---|
2265 | publisher = {AFIPS Press, vol. 39},
|
---|
2266 | address = {Montvale, New Jersey, U.S.A},
|
---|
2267 | year = 1971,
|
---|
2268 | pages = {253-262},
|
---|
2269 | }
|
---|
2270 |
|
---|
2271 | @manual{JavaScript,
|
---|
2272 | keywords = {JavaScript},
|
---|
2273 | contributer = {pabuhr},
|
---|
2274 | title = {ECMAScript 2015 Language Specification {JavaScript}},
|
---|
2275 | organization= {ECAM International},
|
---|
2276 | address = {Rue du Rhone 114, CH-1204 Geneva, Switzerland},
|
---|
2277 | month = jun,
|
---|
2278 | year = 2015,
|
---|
2279 | note = {6th Edition}
|
---|
2280 | }
|
---|
2281 |
|
---|
2282 | @inproceedings{Peterson77,
|
---|
2283 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion},
|
---|
2284 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2285 | author = {Gary L. Peterson and Michael J. Fischer},
|
---|
2286 | title = {Economical Solutions for the Critical Section Problem in a Distributed System (Extended Abstract)},
|
---|
2287 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Ninth Annual ACM Symposium on Theory of Computing},
|
---|
2288 | series = {STOC '77},
|
---|
2289 | year = 1977,
|
---|
2290 | location = {Boulder, Colorado, USA},
|
---|
2291 | pages = {91--97},
|
---|
2292 | numpages = {7},
|
---|
2293 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
2294 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
2295 | }
|
---|
2296 |
|
---|
2297 | @article{Hansen81a,
|
---|
2298 | keywords = {concurrency, monitor, critical region},
|
---|
2299 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2300 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}},
|
---|
2301 | title = {{E}dison---a Multiprocessor Language},
|
---|
2302 | journal = spe,
|
---|
2303 | volume = 11,
|
---|
2304 | number = 4,
|
---|
2305 | month = apr,
|
---|
2306 | year = {1981},
|
---|
2307 | pages = {325-361},
|
---|
2308 | }
|
---|
2309 |
|
---|
2310 | @book{Eiffel,
|
---|
2311 | keywords = {Eiffel},
|
---|
2312 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2313 | author = {Bertrand Meyer},
|
---|
2314 | title = {Eiffel: The Language},
|
---|
2315 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
2316 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
2317 | year = 1992,
|
---|
2318 | series = {Prentice-Hall Object-Oriented Series},
|
---|
2319 | }
|
---|
2320 |
|
---|
2321 | @article{WS:overload,
|
---|
2322 | keywords = {compilation},
|
---|
2323 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2324 | author = {Peter J. L. Wallis and Bernhard W. Silverman},
|
---|
2325 | title = {Efficient Implementation of the {Ada} Overloading Rules},
|
---|
2326 | journal = ipl,
|
---|
2327 | year = 1980,
|
---|
2328 | month = apr, volume = 10, number = 3, pages = {120-123},
|
---|
2329 | comment = {
|
---|
2330 | The ``two-pass'' algorithm. An upward pass over a parse tree
|
---|
2331 | calculates the set of possible result types of operators. The
|
---|
2332 | root must have exactly one type, produced in one way. A
|
---|
2333 | downward pass selects the version of the operator that produces the
|
---|
2334 | desired result type, thus setting the result types of subtrees.
|
---|
2335 | See \cite{D:overload}.
|
---|
2336 | }
|
---|
2337 | }
|
---|
2338 |
|
---|
2339 | @techreport{Habermann80,
|
---|
2340 | keywords = {Ada, threads},
|
---|
2341 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2342 | author = {A. N. Habermann and I. R. Nassi},
|
---|
2343 | title = {Efficient Implementation of {Ada} Tasks},
|
---|
2344 | institution = {Carnegie-Mellon University},
|
---|
2345 | number = {CMU-CS-80-103},
|
---|
2346 | year = 1980
|
---|
2347 | }
|
---|
2348 |
|
---|
2349 | @article{Emerald,
|
---|
2350 | keywords = {concurrency, polymorphism},
|
---|
2351 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2352 | author = {Rajendra K. Raj and Ewan Tempero and Henry M. Levy and Andrew P. Black and Norman C. Hutchinson and Eric Jul},
|
---|
2353 | title = {Emerald: A General-Purpose Programming Language},
|
---|
2354 | journal = spe,
|
---|
2355 | month = jan,
|
---|
2356 | year = 1991,
|
---|
2357 | volume = 21,
|
---|
2358 | number = 1,
|
---|
2359 | pages = {91-118}
|
---|
2360 | }
|
---|
2361 |
|
---|
2362 | @InProceedings{chambers89a,
|
---|
2363 | keywords = {maps, delegation},
|
---|
2364 | author = "Craig Chambers and David Ungar and Elgin Lee",
|
---|
2365 | title = "An Efficient Implementation of {SELF}, a Dynamically-Typed
|
---|
2366 | Object-Oriented Language Based on Prototypes",
|
---|
2367 | crossref = "OOPSLA89",
|
---|
2368 | pages = {49-70}
|
---|
2369 | }
|
---|
2370 |
|
---|
2371 | @article{oop:encapsulation,
|
---|
2372 | keywords = {Encapsulation, Inheritance, Subclasses, Multiple Inheritance},
|
---|
2373 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2374 | author = {Alan Snyder},
|
---|
2375 | title = {Encapsulation and Inheritance in Object-Oriented Programming
|
---|
2376 | Languages},
|
---|
2377 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
2378 | volume = {21}, number = {11},
|
---|
2379 | pages = {38-45},
|
---|
2380 | month = nov, year = 1986,
|
---|
2381 | comment = {
|
---|
2382 | Client, child interfaces should be distinct. Child interface
|
---|
2383 | shouldn't grant total access to parent.
|
---|
2384 |
|
---|
2385 | Rules for redefining parent variable name in a child affect
|
---|
2386 | re-implementation of the parent.
|
---|
2387 |
|
---|
2388 | Inheritance can be a promise to obey the semantics of the parent,
|
---|
2389 | or code reuse; the two may be contradictory. Unification
|
---|
2390 | exposes use of inheritance: a child can not be re-implemented
|
---|
2391 | without breaking code that assumes that it is a subclass of the
|
---|
2392 | original parent. If a class uses the names of its parents'
|
---|
2393 | ancestors, then inheritance is part of the parent's child
|
---|
2394 | interface.
|
---|
2395 |
|
---|
2396 | Linearizing a multiple inheritance tree means that a class's use of
|
---|
2397 | calls on super need to be understood before it is used as a parent.
|
---|
2398 | Merging repeated ancestors exposes inheritance if an ancestor is
|
---|
2399 | re-implemented. Forbidding inheritance of distinct methods with
|
---|
2400 | the same name exposes implementation of ancestors. Proposed
|
---|
2401 | solution treats the set of ancestors as a tree.
|
---|
2402 | }
|
---|
2403 | }
|
---|
2404 |
|
---|
2405 | @article{st:encapsulator,
|
---|
2406 | keywords = {encapsulator, Smalltalk, monitor},
|
---|
2407 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2408 | author = {Geoffrey A. Pascoe},
|
---|
2409 | title = {Encapsulators: A New Software Paradigm in Smalltalk-80},
|
---|
2410 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
2411 | volume = {21}, number = {11},
|
---|
2412 | pages = {341-346},
|
---|
2413 | month = nov, year = 1986,
|
---|
2414 | comment = {
|
---|
2415 | Encapsulators are objects that surround other objects.
|
---|
2416 | Pre- and post-actions are performed when messages are sent to the
|
---|
2417 | encapsulated object. They are created here by sending the message
|
---|
2418 | object: to an encapsulator class. Examples given are monitors,
|
---|
2419 | atomic objects, and Model (for model-view-controller interfaces).
|
---|
2420 |
|
---|
2421 | Encapsulator classes use a family of selectors that the
|
---|
2422 | encapsulated object will not respond to. Messages for the
|
---|
2423 | encapsulated object are passed on by trapping them with the
|
---|
2424 | doesNotUnderstand method. Various fiddles were needed when setting
|
---|
2425 | up the class and metaclass hierarchies. A few selectors (==,
|
---|
2426 | class) always directly invoke primitive methods; they can't be
|
---|
2427 | used.
|
---|
2428 |
|
---|
2429 | Can an encapsulated object be an encapsulator? Probably, but the
|
---|
2430 | middle object's selectors are inaccessible.
|
---|
2431 | }
|
---|
2432 | }
|
---|
2433 |
|
---|
2434 | @manual{EPT,
|
---|
2435 | keywords = {concurrency, light-weight threads},
|
---|
2436 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2437 | key = {Encore},
|
---|
2438 | title = {Encore Parallel Thread Manual, 724-06210},
|
---|
2439 | organization= {Encore Computer Corporation},
|
---|
2440 | month = may,
|
---|
2441 | year = 1988,
|
---|
2442 | }
|
---|
2443 |
|
---|
2444 | @manual{Erlang,
|
---|
2445 | keywords = {Erlang},
|
---|
2446 | contributer = {pabuhr},
|
---|
2447 | title = {Erlang Reference Manual User's Guide, Vertion 7.0},
|
---|
2448 | organization= {Erlang/OTP System Documentation},
|
---|
2449 | address = {1430 Broadway, New York, New York 10018},
|
---|
2450 | month = jun,
|
---|
2451 | year = 2015,
|
---|
2452 | note = {\href{http://www.erlang.org/doc/pdf/otp-system-documentation.pdf}{\textsf{http://www.erlang.org/\-doc/\-pdf/\-otp-system-\-documentation.pdf}}},
|
---|
2453 | }
|
---|
2454 |
|
---|
2455 | @inproceedings{MH88,
|
---|
2456 | keywords = {modules, general sums, general products},
|
---|
2457 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2458 | author = {John C. Mitchell and Robert Harper},
|
---|
2459 | title = {The Essence of {ML}},
|
---|
2460 | booktitle = popl,
|
---|
2461 | year = 1988,
|
---|
2462 | pages = {28-46}
|
---|
2463 | }
|
---|
2464 |
|
---|
2465 | @book{LeVerrand,
|
---|
2466 | keywords = {},
|
---|
2467 | author = {D. Le Verrand},
|
---|
2468 | title = {Evaluating {Ada}},
|
---|
2469 | publisher = {North Oxford Academic},
|
---|
2470 | year = 1985
|
---|
2471 | }
|
---|
2472 |
|
---|
2473 | @inproceedings{Bloom79,
|
---|
2474 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
2475 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2476 | author = {Toby Bloom},
|
---|
2477 | title = {Evaluating Synchronization Mechanisms},
|
---|
2478 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Seventh Symposium on Operating Systems Principles},
|
---|
2479 | organization= {ACM SIGOPS},
|
---|
2480 | address = {Pacific Grove, California, U.S.A},
|
---|
2481 | month = dec,
|
---|
2482 | year = 1979,
|
---|
2483 | pages = {24-32}
|
---|
2484 | }
|
---|
2485 |
|
---|
2486 | @article{Buhr06a,
|
---|
2487 | keywords = {concurrency, C++, uC++},
|
---|
2488 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2489 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Richard C. Bilson},
|
---|
2490 | title = {Examining $\mu${C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} :
|
---|
2491 | High-level Object-Oriented Concurrency in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
2492 | journal = {Dr. Dobb's Journal : Software Tools for the Professional Programmer},
|
---|
2493 | month = feb,
|
---|
2494 | year = 2006,
|
---|
2495 | volume = 31,
|
---|
2496 | number = 2,
|
---|
2497 | pages = {36-40},
|
---|
2498 | }
|
---|
2499 |
|
---|
2500 | @article{ExceptionalC,
|
---|
2501 | keywords = {exception handling, asynchronous events},
|
---|
2502 | contributer = {wyrmok@plg},
|
---|
2503 | author = {N. H. Gehani},
|
---|
2504 | title = {Exceptional {C} or {C} with Exceptions},
|
---|
2505 | journal = spe,
|
---|
2506 | year = 1992,
|
---|
2507 | month = oct,
|
---|
2508 | volume = 22,
|
---|
2509 | number = 10,
|
---|
2510 | pages = {827-848},
|
---|
2511 | comment = {
|
---|
2512 | It is the most extensive exceptional handling mechanism thus
|
---|
2513 | far. Though it doesn't have Mesa resumption, it has
|
---|
2514 | asynchronous signal which is more general and abstract than
|
---|
2515 | the unix signal mechanism. It has an Eiffel like retry
|
---|
2516 | mechanism. Consequently, the scope of guarded region is not
|
---|
2517 | immediately terminated when an exception is raised. In fact,
|
---|
2518 | an exception handler creates a scope under its guarded
|
---|
2519 | region.
|
---|
2520 | }
|
---|
2521 | }
|
---|
2522 |
|
---|
2523 | @incollection{Buhr02,
|
---|
2524 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
2525 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2526 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Ashif Harji and W. Y. Russell Mok},
|
---|
2527 | title = {Exception Handling},
|
---|
2528 | editor = {Marvin V. Zelkowitz},
|
---|
2529 | booktitle = {Advances in COMPUTERS},
|
---|
2530 | publisher = {Academic Press},
|
---|
2531 | address = {London},
|
---|
2532 | volume = 56,
|
---|
2533 | year = 2002,
|
---|
2534 | pages = {245-303},
|
---|
2535 | }
|
---|
2536 |
|
---|
2537 | @article{Cargill94,
|
---|
2538 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
2539 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2540 | author = {Tom Cargill},
|
---|
2541 | title = {Exception Handling: a False Sense of Security},
|
---|
2542 | journal = {{C}{\kern-.2em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.2em+}}} Report},
|
---|
2543 | year = 1994,
|
---|
2544 | month = nov,
|
---|
2545 | volume = 6,
|
---|
2546 | number = 9,
|
---|
2547 | note = {http://www.informit.com/\-content/\-images/\-020163371x/\-supplements/\-Exception\_\-Handling\_\-Article.\-html}
|
---|
2548 | }
|
---|
2549 |
|
---|
2550 | @article{Knudsen84,
|
---|
2551 | keywords = {static exception handling, BETA, sequel},
|
---|
2552 | contributer = {wyrmok@plg},
|
---|
2553 | author = {J{\o}rgen Lindskov Knudsen},
|
---|
2554 | title = {Exception Handling --- A Static Approach},
|
---|
2555 | journal = spe,
|
---|
2556 | year = 1984,
|
---|
2557 | month = may,
|
---|
2558 | volume = 14,
|
---|
2559 | number = 5,
|
---|
2560 | pages = {429-449},
|
---|
2561 | }
|
---|
2562 |
|
---|
2563 | @article{Drew94,
|
---|
2564 | keywords = {exceptions, exception handling},
|
---|
2565 | contributer = {wyrmok@plg},
|
---|
2566 | author = {Steven J. Drew and K. John Gough},
|
---|
2567 | title = {Exception Handling: Expecting the Unexpected},
|
---|
2568 | journal = {Computer Languages},
|
---|
2569 | year = 1994,
|
---|
2570 | month = may,
|
---|
2571 | volume = 20,
|
---|
2572 | number = 2,
|
---|
2573 | comment = {
|
---|
2574 | A recent and good survey on various exception handling mechanisms found
|
---|
2575 | in imperative programming languages. It classifies various mechanism in
|
---|
2576 | terms of flow control and scopes. Asynchronous exceptions and signals
|
---|
2577 | are also covered as Exceptional C is in the survey.
|
---|
2578 | }
|
---|
2579 | }
|
---|
2580 |
|
---|
2581 | @article{Koenig90,
|
---|
2582 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
2583 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2584 | author = {Andrew Koenig and Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
2585 | title = {Exception Handling for {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
2586 | journal = joop,
|
---|
2587 | month = {July/August},
|
---|
2588 | year = 1990,
|
---|
2589 | volume = 3,
|
---|
2590 | number = 2,
|
---|
2591 | pages = {16-33},
|
---|
2592 | }
|
---|
2593 |
|
---|
2594 | @article{Lee83,
|
---|
2595 | keywords = {exception handling, C},
|
---|
2596 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2597 | author = {P. A. Lee},
|
---|
2598 | title = {Exception Handling in {C} Programs},
|
---|
2599 | journal = spe,
|
---|
2600 | volume = 13,
|
---|
2601 | number = 5,
|
---|
2602 | month = may,
|
---|
2603 | year = 1983,
|
---|
2604 | pages = {389-405},
|
---|
2605 | }
|
---|
2606 |
|
---|
2607 | @article{Liskov79,
|
---|
2608 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
2609 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2610 | author = {Barbara H. Liskov and Alan Snyder},
|
---|
2611 | title = {Exception Handling in {CLU}},
|
---|
2612 | journal = ieeese,
|
---|
2613 | month = nov,
|
---|
2614 | year = 1979,
|
---|
2615 | volume = {SE-5},
|
---|
2616 | number = 6,
|
---|
2617 | pages = {546-558},
|
---|
2618 | }
|
---|
2619 |
|
---|
2620 | @article{Szalas85,
|
---|
2621 | keywords = {concurrency, C++},
|
---|
2622 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2623 | author = {Andrzej Szalas and Danuta Szczepanska},
|
---|
2624 | title = {Exception Handling in Parallel Computations},
|
---|
2625 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
2626 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
2627 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
2628 | volume = 20,
|
---|
2629 | number = 10,
|
---|
2630 | month = oct,
|
---|
2631 | year = 1985,
|
---|
2632 | pages = {95-104},
|
---|
2633 | }
|
---|
2634 |
|
---|
2635 | @article{MacLaren77,
|
---|
2636 | keywords = {exception handling, PL/I},
|
---|
2637 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2638 | author = {M. Donald MacLaren},
|
---|
2639 | title = {Exception Handling in {PL/I}},
|
---|
2640 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
2641 | volume = 12,
|
---|
2642 | number = 3,
|
---|
2643 | month = mar,
|
---|
2644 | year = 1977,
|
---|
2645 | pages = {101-104},
|
---|
2646 | note = {Proceedings of an ACM Conference on Language Design for Reliable Software,
|
---|
2647 | March 28--30, 1977, Raleigh, North Carolina, U.S.A.},
|
---|
2648 | }
|
---|
2649 |
|
---|
2650 | @article{Goodenough75,
|
---|
2651 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
2652 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2653 | author = {J. B. Goodenough},
|
---|
2654 | title = {Exception Handling: Issues and a Proposed Notation},
|
---|
2655 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
2656 | month = dec,
|
---|
2657 | year = 1975,
|
---|
2658 | volume = 18,
|
---|
2659 | number = 12,
|
---|
2660 | pages = {683-696},
|
---|
2661 | }
|
---|
2662 |
|
---|
2663 | @article{Lampson80,
|
---|
2664 | keywords = {monitors},
|
---|
2665 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2666 | author = {B. W. Lampson and D. D. Redell},
|
---|
2667 | title = {Experience with Processes and Monitors in Mesa},
|
---|
2668 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
2669 | volume = 23,
|
---|
2670 | number = 2,
|
---|
2671 | month = feb,
|
---|
2672 | year = 1980,
|
---|
2673 | pages = {105-117},
|
---|
2674 | }
|
---|
2675 |
|
---|
2676 | @inproceedings{Shopiro87,
|
---|
2677 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
2678 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2679 | author = {Jonathan E. Shopiro},
|
---|
2680 | title = {Extending the {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Task System for Real-Time Control},
|
---|
2681 | booktitle = {Proceedings and Additional Papers {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Workshop},
|
---|
2682 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
2683 | address = {Santa Fe, New Mexico, U.S.A},
|
---|
2684 | month = nov,
|
---|
2685 | year = 1987,
|
---|
2686 | pages = {77-94}
|
---|
2687 | }
|
---|
2688 |
|
---|
2689 | @article{Modula-2+,
|
---|
2690 | keywords = {Modula-2, exceptions, garbage collection, concurrency},
|
---|
2691 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2692 | author = {Paul Rovner},
|
---|
2693 | title = {Extending Modula-2 to Build Large, Integrated Systems},
|
---|
2694 | journal = {IEEE Software},
|
---|
2695 | month = nov, year = 1986,
|
---|
2696 | volume = 3, number = 6, pages = {46-57},
|
---|
2697 | comment = {
|
---|
2698 | Exceptions can have a parameter. Procedures can declare the
|
---|
2699 | exceptions they can propagate; others are converted to {\tt
|
---|
2700 | SYSTEM.Fail}. If they don't, all exceptions propagate.
|
---|
2701 | Block cleanup statements execute no matter how control leaves the
|
---|
2702 | block.
|
---|
2703 |
|
---|
2704 | {\tt REF t} is a garbage-collected pointer. A {\tt REFANY} can be
|
---|
2705 | assigned any {\tt REF t}. Open array types can be used in
|
---|
2706 | parameter and {\tt REF} types. {\tt NEW} creates arrays of fixed,
|
---|
2707 | dynamically determined size.
|
---|
2708 |
|
---|
2709 | The {\tt THREAD} module provides lightweight processes, semaphores,
|
---|
2710 | and conditions. A statement {\tt LOCK {\em semaphore} DO
|
---|
2711 | {\em statements} END} is built in.
|
---|
2712 |
|
---|
2713 | {\tt SAFE} modules do run-time checks, and only import {\tt
|
---|
2714 | SAFE} modules. One implementation module can implement several
|
---|
2715 | definition modules. Opaque type implementations can be
|
---|
2716 | repeated in modules that import its definition, so implementation
|
---|
2717 | modules can collaborate. The linker checks that all
|
---|
2718 | implementations are the same.
|
---|
2719 | }
|
---|
2720 | }
|
---|
2721 |
|
---|
2722 | @inproceedings{BNRPascal,
|
---|
2723 | keywords = {concurrency, rendezvous},
|
---|
2724 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2725 | author = {R. Kamel and N. Gammage},
|
---|
2726 | title = {Experience with Rendezvous},
|
---|
2727 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 1988 International Conference on Computer Languages},
|
---|
2728 | month = oct,
|
---|
2729 | year = 1988,
|
---|
2730 | pages = {143-149}
|
---|
2731 | }
|
---|
2732 |
|
---|
2733 | % F
|
---|
2734 |
|
---|
2735 | @inproceedings{Knudsen01,
|
---|
2736 | keywords = {Beta, exception handling},
|
---|
2737 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2738 | author = {J{\o}rgen Lindskov Knudsen},
|
---|
2739 | title = {Fault Tolerance and Exception Handling in {BETA}},
|
---|
2740 | booktitle = {Exception Handling},
|
---|
2741 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
2742 | volume = 2022,
|
---|
2743 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
2744 | year = 2001,
|
---|
2745 | pages = {1-17}
|
---|
2746 | }
|
---|
2747 |
|
---|
2748 | @article{Lamport87,
|
---|
2749 | keywords = {software solutions, mutual exclusion, fast},
|
---|
2750 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2751 | author = {Leslie Lamport},
|
---|
2752 | title = {A Fast Mutual Exclusion Algorithm},
|
---|
2753 | journal = tocs,
|
---|
2754 | volume = 5,
|
---|
2755 | number = 1,
|
---|
2756 | month = jan,
|
---|
2757 | year = {1987},
|
---|
2758 | pages = {1--11},
|
---|
2759 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
2760 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
2761 | }
|
---|
2762 |
|
---|
2763 | @inproceedings{F-bound,
|
---|
2764 | keywords = {},
|
---|
2765 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2766 | author = {Peter Canning and William Cook and Walter Hill and Walter Olthoff and John C. Mitchell},
|
---|
2767 | title = {F-Bounded Polymorphism for Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
2768 | booktitle = {Fourth International Conference on Functional Programming Languages and Computer Architecture},
|
---|
2769 | year = 1989,
|
---|
2770 | month = sep,
|
---|
2771 | pages = {273-280}
|
---|
2772 | }
|
---|
2773 |
|
---|
2774 | @mastersthesis{Wasik08,
|
---|
2775 | author = {Ayelet Wasik},
|
---|
2776 | title = {Features of a Multi-Threaded Memory Allocator},
|
---|
2777 | school = {University of Waterloo},
|
---|
2778 | year = 2008,
|
---|
2779 | month = jan,
|
---|
2780 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
2781 | note = {\textsf{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/\-bitstream/\-10012/\-3501/\-1/\-Thesis.pdf}},
|
---|
2782 | }
|
---|
2783 |
|
---|
2784 | @article{Holzmann94,
|
---|
2785 | keywords = {semaphore, flags},
|
---|
2786 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2787 | author = {Gerard J. Holzmann and Bj\"{o}rn Pehrson},
|
---|
2788 | title = {The First Data Networks},
|
---|
2789 | journal = {Scientific American},
|
---|
2790 | month = jan,
|
---|
2791 | year = 1994,
|
---|
2792 | volume = 12,
|
---|
2793 | number = 1,
|
---|
2794 | pages = {124-129},
|
---|
2795 | }
|
---|
2796 |
|
---|
2797 | @article{Bohm66,
|
---|
2798 | keywords = {goto, structured programming},
|
---|
2799 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2800 | author = {C. B\"{o}hm and G. Jacopini},
|
---|
2801 | title = {Flow diagrams, Turing Machines and Languages with only two Formation Rules},
|
---|
2802 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
2803 | month = may,
|
---|
2804 | year = 1966,
|
---|
2805 | volume = 9,
|
---|
2806 | number = 5,
|
---|
2807 | pages = {366-371},
|
---|
2808 | }
|
---|
2809 |
|
---|
2810 | @manual{Fortran95,
|
---|
2811 | keywords = {Fortran 95},
|
---|
2812 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2813 | key = {Fortran95},
|
---|
2814 | title = {Fortran 95 Standard, ISO/IEC 1539},
|
---|
2815 | organization = {Unicomp, Inc.},
|
---|
2816 | address = {7660 E. Broadway, Tucson, Arizona, U.S.A, 85710},
|
---|
2817 | month = jan,
|
---|
2818 | year = 1997,
|
---|
2819 | }
|
---|
2820 |
|
---|
2821 | @manual{Fortran08,
|
---|
2822 | keywords = {ISO/IEC Fortran 08},
|
---|
2823 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2824 | key = {Fortran08},
|
---|
2825 | title = {Programming Languages -- {Fortran} Part 1},
|
---|
2826 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 1989:2014},
|
---|
2827 | publisher = {International Standard Organization},
|
---|
2828 | address = {http://www.iso.org},
|
---|
2829 | year = 2010,
|
---|
2830 | }
|
---|
2831 |
|
---|
2832 | @book{Andrews00:book,
|
---|
2833 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
2834 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2835 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews},
|
---|
2836 | title = {Foundations of Multithreaded, Parallel and Distributed Programming},
|
---|
2837 | publisher = {Addison--Wesley},
|
---|
2838 | year = 2000,
|
---|
2839 | }
|
---|
2840 |
|
---|
2841 | @article{Agha89,
|
---|
2842 | keywords = {actors, concurrency},
|
---|
2843 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2844 | author = {Gul A. Agha},
|
---|
2845 | title = {Foundational Issues in Concurrent Computing},
|
---|
2846 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
2847 | month = apr,
|
---|
2848 | year = 1989,
|
---|
2849 | volume = 24,
|
---|
2850 | number = 4,
|
---|
2851 | pages = {60-65},
|
---|
2852 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN Workshop on Object-Based Concurrent Programming,
|
---|
2853 | Sept. 26--27, 1988, San Diego, California, U.S.A},
|
---|
2854 | }
|
---|
2855 |
|
---|
2856 | @article{ool,
|
---|
2857 | keywords = {},
|
---|
2858 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2859 | author = {Douglas T. Ross},
|
---|
2860 | title = {Toward Foundations for the Understanding of Type},
|
---|
2861 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
2862 | year = 1976,
|
---|
2863 | volume = 11, pages = {63-65},
|
---|
2864 | note = {Conference on Data: Abstraction, Definition and Structure},
|
---|
2865 | summary = {
|
---|
2866 | Possibly the first use (without definition, alas) of the phrase
|
---|
2867 | "object oriented language". Metaphysical to the point of incoherence.
|
---|
2868 | }
|
---|
2869 | }
|
---|
2870 |
|
---|
2871 | @article{frames,
|
---|
2872 | keywords = {frames},
|
---|
2873 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2874 | author = {Paul G. Basset},
|
---|
2875 | title = {Frame-Based Software Engineering},
|
---|
2876 | journal = {IEEE Software},
|
---|
2877 | month = jul, year = 1987,
|
---|
2878 | volume = 4, number = 4, pages = {9-16}
|
---|
2879 | }
|
---|
2880 |
|
---|
2881 | @article{Sutter05,
|
---|
2882 | keywords = {concurrency, C++},
|
---|
2883 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2884 | author = {Herb Sutter},
|
---|
2885 | title = {A Fundamental Turn Toward Concurrency in Software},
|
---|
2886 | journal = {Dr. Dobb's Journal : Software Tools for the Professional Programmer},
|
---|
2887 | month = mar,
|
---|
2888 | year = 2005,
|
---|
2889 | volume = 30,
|
---|
2890 | number = 3,
|
---|
2891 | pages = {16-22},
|
---|
2892 | }
|
---|
2893 |
|
---|
2894 | @inproceedings{Dony01,
|
---|
2895 | keywords = {Smalltalk, exception handling},
|
---|
2896 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2897 | author = {Chistophe Dony},
|
---|
2898 | title = {A Fully Object-Oriented Exception Handling System: Rationale and Smalltalk Implementation},
|
---|
2899 | booktitle = {Exception Handling},
|
---|
2900 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
2901 | volume = 2022,
|
---|
2902 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
2903 | year = 2001,
|
---|
2904 | pages = {18-38}
|
---|
2905 | }
|
---|
2906 |
|
---|
2907 | @misc{FW,
|
---|
2908 | key = {FW},
|
---|
2909 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2910 | title = {Funk \& Wagnalls Standard Desk Dictionary},
|
---|
2911 | year = 1980
|
---|
2912 | }
|
---|
2913 |
|
---|
2914 | @book{Knuth73V1,
|
---|
2915 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2916 | author = {Donald E. Knuth},
|
---|
2917 | title = {Fundamental Algorithms},
|
---|
2918 | series = {The Art of Computer Programming},
|
---|
2919 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
2920 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
2921 | year = 1973,
|
---|
2922 | volume = 1,
|
---|
2923 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
2924 | }
|
---|
2925 |
|
---|
2926 | @inproceedings{Strachey,
|
---|
2927 | keywords = {polymorphism},
|
---|
2928 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2929 | author = {C. Strachey},
|
---|
2930 | title = {Fundamental Concepts in Programming Languages},
|
---|
2931 | booktitle = {Lecture Notes for the International Summer School in Computer Programming},
|
---|
2932 | year = 1967,
|
---|
2933 | month = aug,
|
---|
2934 | address = {Copenhagen},
|
---|
2935 | comment = {
|
---|
2936 | Defines ad-hoc and parametric polymorphism.
|
---|
2937 | }
|
---|
2938 | }
|
---|
2939 |
|
---|
2940 | @article{Eisenberg72,
|
---|
2941 | keywords = {concurrency, N-Process solution, O(N)},
|
---|
2942 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
2943 | author = {Murray A. Eisenberg and Michael R. McGuire},
|
---|
2944 | title = {Further Comments on {D}ijkstra's Concurrent Programming Control Problem},
|
---|
2945 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
2946 | month = nov,
|
---|
2947 | year = 1972,
|
---|
2948 | volume = 15,
|
---|
2949 | number = 11,
|
---|
2950 | pages = {999},
|
---|
2951 | }
|
---|
2952 |
|
---|
2953 | % G
|
---|
2954 |
|
---|
2955 | @article{Boehm88,
|
---|
2956 | keywords = {conservative garbage collection, C},
|
---|
2957 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2958 | author = {Hans-Juergen Boehm and Mark Weiser},
|
---|
2959 | title = {Garbage Collection in an Uncooperative Environment},
|
---|
2960 | journal = spe,
|
---|
2961 | month = sep,
|
---|
2962 | year = 1988,
|
---|
2963 | volume = 18,
|
---|
2964 | number = 9,
|
---|
2965 | pages = {807-820}
|
---|
2966 | }
|
---|
2967 |
|
---|
2968 | @manual{gcc,
|
---|
2969 | keywords = {},
|
---|
2970 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2971 | title = {GCC},
|
---|
2972 | author = {Richard M. Stallman},
|
---|
2973 | organization= {Free Software Foundation},
|
---|
2974 | address = {Cambridge}
|
---|
2975 | }
|
---|
2976 |
|
---|
2977 | @article{doUpon,
|
---|
2978 | keywords = {formal verification, axiomatic semantics, control structures},
|
---|
2979 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
2980 | author = {Ed Anson},
|
---|
2981 | title = {A Generalized Iterative Construct and Its Semantics},
|
---|
2982 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
2983 | volume = {9}, number = {4},
|
---|
2984 | pages = {567-581},
|
---|
2985 | month = oct, year = 1987,
|
---|
2986 | comment = {
|
---|
2987 | \begin{verbatim}
|
---|
2988 | do
|
---|
2989 | P1 -> L1
|
---|
2990 | [] P2 -> L2
|
---|
2991 | ...
|
---|
2992 | [] Pm -> Lm
|
---|
2993 | upon
|
---|
2994 | Q1 -> M1
|
---|
2995 | [] Q2 -> M2
|
---|
2996 | ...
|
---|
2997 | [] qn -> mn
|
---|
2998 | od
|
---|
2999 | \end{verbatim}
|
---|
3000 |
|
---|
3001 | If there is an i such that Qi is true, execute Mi and terminate.
|
---|
3002 | Otherwise, if there is an i such that Pi is true, execute Li and
|
---|
3003 | repeat the loop. Otherwise, fail.
|
---|
3004 | }
|
---|
3005 | }
|
---|
3006 |
|
---|
3007 | @unpublished{Bilson,
|
---|
3008 | keywords = {generic programming, generics, polymorphism},
|
---|
3009 | contributor = {a3moss@plg},
|
---|
3010 | author = {Richard C. Bilson and Glen Ditchfield and Peter A. Buhr},
|
---|
3011 | title = {Generic Programming with Inferred Models},
|
---|
3012 | }
|
---|
3013 |
|
---|
3014 | @article{Haskell,
|
---|
3015 | keywords = {lazy evaluation, type class},
|
---|
3016 | contributer = {pabuhr},
|
---|
3017 | author = {Paul Hudak and Joseph H. Fasel},
|
---|
3018 | title = {A Gentle Introduction to Haskell},
|
---|
3019 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
3020 | volume = 27,
|
---|
3021 | number = 5,
|
---|
3022 | month = may,
|
---|
3023 | year = 1992,
|
---|
3024 | pages = {T1-53},
|
---|
3025 | }
|
---|
3026 |
|
---|
3027 | @manual{Go,
|
---|
3028 | keywords = {Go programming language},
|
---|
3029 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3030 | title = {{Go} Programming Language},
|
---|
3031 | author = {Robert Griesemer and Rob Pike and Ken Thompson},
|
---|
3032 | organization= {Google},
|
---|
3033 | year = 2009,
|
---|
3034 | note = {\href{http://golang.org/ref/spec}{http://\-golang.org/\-ref/\-spec}},
|
---|
3035 | }
|
---|
3036 |
|
---|
3037 | @article{Dijkstra68a,
|
---|
3038 | keywords = {goto},
|
---|
3039 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3040 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
3041 | title = {Go To Statement Considered Harmful},
|
---|
3042 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
3043 | month = mar,
|
---|
3044 | year = 1968,
|
---|
3045 | volume = 11,
|
---|
3046 | number = 3,
|
---|
3047 | pages = {147-148},
|
---|
3048 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{Yourdon79} pp. 29--36.},
|
---|
3049 | }
|
---|
3050 |
|
---|
3051 | @article{Choi91,
|
---|
3052 | keywords = {contra-variance, functions},
|
---|
3053 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3054 | author = {Injun Choi and Michael V. Mannino},
|
---|
3055 | title = {Graph Interpretation of Methods: A Unifying Framework for Polymorphism in Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
3056 | journal = {OOPS Messenger},
|
---|
3057 | volume = 2,
|
---|
3058 | number = 1,
|
---|
3059 | month = jan,
|
---|
3060 | year = 1991,
|
---|
3061 | pages = {38-54},
|
---|
3062 | }
|
---|
3063 |
|
---|
3064 | @misc{GNU-C,
|
---|
3065 | keywords = {C, ANSI C},
|
---|
3066 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3067 | author = {Richard Stallman},
|
---|
3068 | title = {The Free Software Foundation's Gnu {C} Compiler},
|
---|
3069 | howpublished= {Free Software Foundation, 1000 Mass Ave., Cambridge, MA, U.S.A., 02138},
|
---|
3070 | year = 1989,
|
---|
3071 | }
|
---|
3072 |
|
---|
3073 | @article{Dijkstra:green,
|
---|
3074 | keywords = {ada},
|
---|
3075 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3076 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
3077 | title = {On the GREEN Language submitted to the DoD},
|
---|
3078 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
3079 | year = 1978,
|
---|
3080 | month = oct,
|
---|
3081 | volume = 13,
|
---|
3082 | number = 10,
|
---|
3083 | pages = {16-21}
|
---|
3084 | }
|
---|
3085 |
|
---|
3086 | @inproceedings{Miller02,
|
---|
3087 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
3088 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3089 | author = {Robert Miller and Anand Tripathi},
|
---|
3090 | title = {The Guardian Model for Exception Handling in Distributed Systems},
|
---|
3091 | booktitle = {21st Symposium on Reliable Distributed Systems},
|
---|
3092 | organization= {IEEE},
|
---|
3093 | address = {Suita, Japan},
|
---|
3094 | year = 2002,
|
---|
3095 | month = oct,
|
---|
3096 | pages = {304-313}
|
---|
3097 | }
|
---|
3098 |
|
---|
3099 | @phdthesis{Chen09,
|
---|
3100 | author = {Jun Chen},
|
---|
3101 | title = {Guided Testing of Concurrent Programs Using Value Schedules},
|
---|
3102 | school = {University of Waterloo},
|
---|
3103 | year = 2009,
|
---|
3104 | month = sep,
|
---|
3105 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
3106 | note = {\textsf{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/bitstream/\-10012/\-4735/\-1/\-Chen-Jun.pdf}},
|
---|
3107 | }
|
---|
3108 |
|
---|
3109 | @misc{GNU-C++,
|
---|
3110 | keywords = {C++, GNU C},
|
---|
3111 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3112 | author = {Michael D. Tiemann},
|
---|
3113 | title = {User's Guide to GNU {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
3114 | howpublished= {Free Software Foundation, 1000 Mass Ave., Cambridge, MA, U.S.A., 02138},
|
---|
3115 | month = mar,
|
---|
3116 | year = 1990,
|
---|
3117 | }
|
---|
3118 |
|
---|
3119 | % H
|
---|
3120 |
|
---|
3121 | @article{Michael04a,
|
---|
3122 | keywords = {Lock-free, synchronization, concurrent programming, memory management, multiprogramming, dynamic data structures},
|
---|
3123 | author = {Maged M. Michael},
|
---|
3124 | title = {Hazard Pointers: Safe Memory Reclamation for Lock-Free Objects},
|
---|
3125 | journal = ieeepds,
|
---|
3126 | volume = 15,
|
---|
3127 | number = 6,
|
---|
3128 | month = jun,
|
---|
3129 | year = 2004,
|
---|
3130 | pages = {491-504},
|
---|
3131 | publisher = {IEEE Press},
|
---|
3132 | address = {Piscataway, NJ, USA},
|
---|
3133 | }
|
---|
3134 |
|
---|
3135 | @techreport{Hermes90,
|
---|
3136 | keywords = {processes, distributed computing},
|
---|
3137 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3138 | author = {Robert E. Strom and David F. Bacon and Arthur P. Goldberg and Andy Lowry and Daniel M. Yellin and Shaula Alexander Yemini},
|
---|
3139 | title = {Hermes: A Language for Distributed Computing},
|
---|
3140 | institution = {IBM T. J. Watson Research Center},
|
---|
3141 | address = {Yorktown Heights, New York, U.S.A., 10598},
|
---|
3142 | month = oct,
|
---|
3143 | year = 1990,
|
---|
3144 | }
|
---|
3145 |
|
---|
3146 | @book{Hermes91,
|
---|
3147 | keywords = {processes, distributed computing},
|
---|
3148 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3149 | author = {Robert E. Strom and David F. Bacon and Arthur P. Goldberg and Andy Lowry and Daniel M. Yellin and Shaula Alexander Yemini},
|
---|
3150 | title = {Hermes: A Language for Distributed Computing},
|
---|
3151 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
3152 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
3153 | series = {Innovative Technology},
|
---|
3154 | year = 1991,
|
---|
3155 | }
|
---|
3156 |
|
---|
3157 | @article{katzenelson83b,
|
---|
3158 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3159 | author = "Jacob Katzenelsen",
|
---|
3160 | title = "Higher Level Programming and Data Abstraction---A Case Study using Enhanced C",
|
---|
3161 | journal = spe,
|
---|
3162 | year = 1983,
|
---|
3163 | volume = 13,
|
---|
3164 | number = 7,
|
---|
3165 | pages = {577-596},
|
---|
3166 | month = jul
|
---|
3167 | }
|
---|
3168 |
|
---|
3169 | @techreport{Hoare73,
|
---|
3170 | keywords = {},
|
---|
3171 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3172 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare},
|
---|
3173 | title = {Hints on Programming Language Design},
|
---|
3174 | institution = {Stanford University Computer Science Department},
|
---|
3175 | year = 1973,
|
---|
3176 | month = dec,
|
---|
3177 | number = {CS-73-403},
|
---|
3178 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{pldesign}.}
|
---|
3179 | }
|
---|
3180 |
|
---|
3181 | @article{Dijkstra71,
|
---|
3182 | keywords = {monitor, secretary},
|
---|
3183 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3184 | author = {E. W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
3185 | title = {Hierarchical Ordering of Sequential Processes},
|
---|
3186 | journal = acta,
|
---|
3187 | volume = 1,
|
---|
3188 | pages = {115-138},
|
---|
3189 | year = 1971,
|
---|
3190 | }
|
---|
3191 |
|
---|
3192 | @article{Buhr15a,
|
---|
3193 | keywords = {software solution, mutual exclusion, performance experiment},
|
---|
3194 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and David Dice and Wim H. Hesselink},
|
---|
3195 | title = {High-Performance {$N$}-Thread Software Solutions for Mutual Exclusion},
|
---|
3196 | journal = ccpe,
|
---|
3197 | volume = 27,
|
---|
3198 | number = 3,
|
---|
3199 | pages = {651-701},
|
---|
3200 | month = mar,
|
---|
3201 | year = 2015,
|
---|
3202 | }
|
---|
3203 |
|
---|
3204 | @article{Ackermann28,
|
---|
3205 | keywords = {recursion, Ackermann function},
|
---|
3206 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3207 | author = {Wilhelm Ackermann},
|
---|
3208 | title = {Zum Hilbertschen Aufbau der reellen Zahlen},
|
---|
3209 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
3210 | journal = mathann,
|
---|
3211 | number = 1,
|
---|
3212 | volume = 99,
|
---|
3213 | pages = {118-133},
|
---|
3214 | month = dec,
|
---|
3215 | year = 1928,
|
---|
3216 | }
|
---|
3217 |
|
---|
3218 | @inproceedings{typeclass,
|
---|
3219 | keywords = {Hindley/Miller type systems, Haskell},
|
---|
3220 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3221 | author = {Philip Wadler and Stephen Blott},
|
---|
3222 | title = {How to make {\em Ad-Hoc} Polymorphism Less {\em Ad-Hoc}},
|
---|
3223 | booktitle = popl,
|
---|
3224 | year = 1989,
|
---|
3225 | pages = {60-76},
|
---|
3226 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}
|
---|
3227 | }
|
---|
3228 |
|
---|
3229 | % I
|
---|
3230 |
|
---|
3231 | @book{IBM370,
|
---|
3232 | keywords = {370, IBM},
|
---|
3233 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3234 | key = {IBM370},
|
---|
3235 | title = {{IBM} System/370 Principles of Operation},
|
---|
3236 | publisher = {IBM},
|
---|
3237 | number = {GA22-7000-8},
|
---|
3238 | month = oct,
|
---|
3239 | year = 1981,
|
---|
3240 | edition = {9th}
|
---|
3241 | }
|
---|
3242 |
|
---|
3243 | @book{Icon,
|
---|
3244 | keywords = {Icon},
|
---|
3245 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3246 | author = {Ralph E. Griswold and Madge T. Griswold},
|
---|
3247 | title = {The Icon Programming Language},
|
---|
3248 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
3249 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
3250 | year = 1983,
|
---|
3251 | }
|
---|
3252 |
|
---|
3253 | @inproceedings{Valois94,
|
---|
3254 | keywords = {lock free, queue},
|
---|
3255 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3256 | author = {John D. Valois},
|
---|
3257 | title = {Implementing Lock-Free Queues},
|
---|
3258 | booktitle = {Seventh International Conference on Parallel and Distributed Computing Systems},
|
---|
3259 | address = {Las Vegas, Nevada, U.S.A.},
|
---|
3260 | year = {1994},
|
---|
3261 | pages = {64-69},
|
---|
3262 | }
|
---|
3263 |
|
---|
3264 | @article{Hehner81,
|
---|
3265 | keywords = {concurrency, critical section, bakery algorithm},
|
---|
3266 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3267 | author = {Eric C. R. Hehner and R. K. Shyamasundar},
|
---|
3268 | title = {An Implementation of {P} and {V}},
|
---|
3269 | journal = ipl,
|
---|
3270 | year = 1981,
|
---|
3271 | month = aug,
|
---|
3272 | volume = 12,
|
---|
3273 | number = 4,
|
---|
3274 | pages = {196-198},
|
---|
3275 | }
|
---|
3276 |
|
---|
3277 | @incollection{Steenkiste91,
|
---|
3278 | keywords = {lisp},
|
---|
3279 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3280 | author = {Peter A. Steenkiste},
|
---|
3281 | title = {The Implementation of Tags and Run-Time Checking},
|
---|
3282 | booktitle = {Topics in Advanced Language Implementation},
|
---|
3283 | pages = {3-24},
|
---|
3284 | year = 1991,
|
---|
3285 | editor = {Peter Lee},
|
---|
3286 | chapter = {1},
|
---|
3287 | publisher = {The MIT Press}
|
---|
3288 | }
|
---|
3289 |
|
---|
3290 | @techreport{Roberts89,
|
---|
3291 | keywords = {},
|
---|
3292 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3293 | author = {Eric S. Roberts},
|
---|
3294 | title = {Implementing Exceptions in {C}},
|
---|
3295 | institution = {Digital Systems Research Center},
|
---|
3296 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, California, 94301},
|
---|
3297 | number = {40},
|
---|
3298 | month = mar,
|
---|
3299 | year = 1989,
|
---|
3300 | }
|
---|
3301 |
|
---|
3302 | @mastersthesis{Bilson03,
|
---|
3303 | keywords = {Cforall, parametric polymorphism, overloading},
|
---|
3304 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3305 | author = {Richard C. Bilson},
|
---|
3306 | title = {Implementing Overloading and Polymorphism in Cforall},
|
---|
3307 | school = {School of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
3308 | year = 2003,
|
---|
3309 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
3310 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/theses/BilsonThesis.pdf}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-theses/\-BilsonThesis.pdf}},
|
---|
3311 | }
|
---|
3312 |
|
---|
3313 | @article{Buhr05b,
|
---|
3314 | keywords = {monitor, automatic signal, implicit signal},
|
---|
3315 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3316 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Ashif S. Harji},
|
---|
3317 | title = {Implicit-signal monitors},
|
---|
3318 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
3319 | volume = 27,
|
---|
3320 | number = 6,
|
---|
3321 | month = nov,
|
---|
3322 | year = 2005,
|
---|
3323 | issn = {0164-0925},
|
---|
3324 | pages = {1270--1343},
|
---|
3325 | publisher = {ACM Press},
|
---|
3326 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
3327 | }
|
---|
3328 |
|
---|
3329 | @article{Baker77,
|
---|
3330 | author = {Henry C. Baker, Jr. and Carl Hewitt},
|
---|
3331 | title = {The Incremental Garbage Collection of Processes},
|
---|
3332 | journal = {SIGART Bulletin},
|
---|
3333 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
3334 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
3335 | month = aug,
|
---|
3336 | year = 1977,
|
---|
3337 | pages = {55-59},
|
---|
3338 | issn = {0163-5719},
|
---|
3339 | }
|
---|
3340 |
|
---|
3341 | @book{Algol68,
|
---|
3342 | keywords = {Algol68},
|
---|
3343 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3344 | author = {C. H. Lindsey and S. G. van der Meulen},
|
---|
3345 | title = {Informal Introduction to ALGOL 68},
|
---|
3346 | publisher = {North-Holland},
|
---|
3347 | address = {London},
|
---|
3348 | year = 1977,
|
---|
3349 | }
|
---|
3350 |
|
---|
3351 | @inproceedings{Cook90,
|
---|
3352 | keywords = {f-bounded polymorhpism, lambda calculus},
|
---|
3353 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3354 | author = {William R. Cook and Walter L. Hill and Peter S. Canning},
|
---|
3355 | title = {Inheritance is Not Subtyping},
|
---|
3356 | booktitle = popl,
|
---|
3357 | year = 1990,
|
---|
3358 | pages = {125-135},
|
---|
3359 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
3360 | abstract = {
|
---|
3361 | In typed object-oriented languages the subtype relation is
|
---|
3362 | typically based on the inheritance hierarchy. This approach,
|
---|
3363 | however, leads either to insecure type-systems or to restrictions
|
---|
3364 | on inheritance that make it less flexible than untyped Smalltalk
|
---|
3365 | inheritance. We present a new typed model of inheritance that
|
---|
3366 | allows more of the flexibility of Smalltalk inheritance within a
|
---|
3367 | statically-typed system. Significant features of our analysis are
|
---|
3368 | the introduction of polymorphism into the typing of inheritance and
|
---|
3369 | the uniform application of inheritance to objects, classes and
|
---|
3370 | types. The resulting notion of {\em type inheritance} allows us to
|
---|
3371 | show that the type of an inherited object is an inherited type but
|
---|
3372 | not always a subtype.
|
---|
3373 | }
|
---|
3374 | }
|
---|
3375 |
|
---|
3376 | @inproceedings{MMR92,
|
---|
3377 | keywords = {},
|
---|
3378 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3379 | author = {Robert E. Minnear and Patrick A. Muckelbauer and Vincent F. Russo},
|
---|
3380 | title = {Integrating the {Sun Microsystems} {XDR/RPC} Protocols
|
---|
3381 | into the {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Stream Model},
|
---|
3382 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
3383 | year = 1992,
|
---|
3384 | month = aug,
|
---|
3385 | pages = {295-312},
|
---|
3386 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
3387 | address = {2590 Ninth Street, Suite 215, Berkeley, CA 94710},
|
---|
3388 | abstract = {
|
---|
3389 | This paper reports our experiences integrating the Sun Microsystems
|
---|
3390 | RPC and XDR protocol specifications into the C++ model of
|
---|
3391 | input/output streams. As part of the {\it Renaissance} operating
|
---|
3392 | system project, we wish to construct network servers and clients,
|
---|
3393 | written in C++, which interoperate with existing UNIX clients
|
---|
3394 | and servers. We discovered that, although it would be possible to
|
---|
3395 | re-implement the procedural based XDR/RPC implementation
|
---|
3396 | distributed by Sun Microsystems in C++, it is far cleaner to
|
---|
3397 | integrate the protocols with the C++ I/O stream model. We
|
---|
3398 | feel the resulting model provides a cleaner way of implementing RPC
|
---|
3399 | clients and servers without losing functionality or compatibility
|
---|
3400 | with existing clients and servers.
|
---|
3401 | }
|
---|
3402 | }
|
---|
3403 |
|
---|
3404 | @inproceedings{Zuo08,
|
---|
3405 | keywords = {shared memory systems,intelligent multiport memory,multiprocessors systems,shared memory system},
|
---|
3406 | author = {Wang Zuo and Wang Zuo and Li Jiaxing},
|
---|
3407 | title = {An Intelligent Multi-Port Memory},
|
---|
3408 | booktitle = {Symposium on Intelligent Information Technology Application Workshops, Shanghai, China},
|
---|
3409 | month = dec,
|
---|
3410 | year = 2008,
|
---|
3411 | pages = {251-254},
|
---|
3412 | publisher = {IEEE Computer Society},
|
---|
3413 | address = {Los Alamitos, CA, USA},
|
---|
3414 | }
|
---|
3415 |
|
---|
3416 | @book{Francez96,
|
---|
3417 | keywords = {await, formal},
|
---|
3418 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3419 | author = {Nissim Francez and Ira R. Forman},
|
---|
3420 | title = {Interacting Processes: A Multiparty Approach to Coordinated Distributed Programming},
|
---|
3421 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
3422 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
3423 | series = {ACM Press Books},
|
---|
3424 | year = 1996,
|
---|
3425 | }
|
---|
3426 |
|
---|
3427 | @article{Labreche90,
|
---|
3428 | keywords = {concurrency, C++},
|
---|
3429 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3430 | author = {Pierre Labr{\`{e}}che},
|
---|
3431 | title = {Interactors: A Real-Time Executive with Multiparty Interactions in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
3432 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
3433 | volume = 25,
|
---|
3434 | number = 4,
|
---|
3435 | month = apr,
|
---|
3436 | year = 1990,
|
---|
3437 | pages = {20-32},
|
---|
3438 | }
|
---|
3439 |
|
---|
3440 | @inproceedings{interfaces,
|
---|
3441 | keywords = {parameterized interfaces, classes, recursion/inheritance},
|
---|
3442 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3443 | author = {Peter S. Canning and William R. Cook and Walter L. Hill and
|
---|
3444 | Walter G. Olthoff},
|
---|
3445 | title = {Interfaces for Strongly-Typed Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
3446 | crossref = "OOPSLA89",
|
---|
3447 | pages = {457-467},
|
---|
3448 | abstract = {
|
---|
3449 | This paper develops a system of explicit interfaces for
|
---|
3450 | object-oriented programming. The system provides the benefits of
|
---|
3451 | module interfaces found in languages like Ada and Modula-2 while
|
---|
3452 | preserving the expressiveness that gives untyped object-oriented
|
---|
3453 | languages like Smalltalk their flexibility. Interfaces are
|
---|
3454 | interpreted as polymorphic types to make the system sufficiently
|
---|
3455 | powerful. We use interfaces to analyze the properties of
|
---|
3456 | inheritance, and identify three distinct kinds of inheritance in
|
---|
3457 | object-oriented programming, corresponding to objects, classes, and
|
---|
3458 | interfaces, respectively. Object interfaces clarify the
|
---|
3459 | distinction between interface containment and inheritance and give
|
---|
3460 | insight into limitations caused by equating the notions of type and
|
---|
3461 | class in many typed object-oriented programming languages.
|
---|
3462 | Interfaces also have practical consequences for design,
|
---|
3463 | specification, and maintenance of object-oriented systems.
|
---|
3464 | }
|
---|
3465 | }
|
---|
3466 |
|
---|
3467 | @phdthesis{Girard72,
|
---|
3468 | keywords = {universal quantification},
|
---|
3469 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3470 | author = {J.-Y. Girard},
|
---|
3471 | title = {Interpretation fonctionelle et elimination des coupures de
|
---|
3472 | l'arithmetique d'ordre superieur},
|
---|
3473 | school = {Universite Paris},
|
---|
3474 | year = {1972}
|
---|
3475 | }
|
---|
3476 |
|
---|
3477 | @article{Karaorman93,
|
---|
3478 | keywords = {Eiffel, concurrency libraries},
|
---|
3479 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3480 | author = {Murat Karaorman and John Bruno},
|
---|
3481 | title = {Introducing Concurrency to a Sequential Language},
|
---|
3482 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
3483 | month = sep,
|
---|
3484 | year = 1993,
|
---|
3485 | volume = 36,
|
---|
3486 | number = 9,
|
---|
3487 | pages = {103-116}
|
---|
3488 | }
|
---|
3489 |
|
---|
3490 | @book{Corman92,
|
---|
3491 | keywords = {PRAM, parallel algorithms},
|
---|
3492 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3493 | author = {Thomas H. Cormen and Charles E. Leiserson and Ronald L. Rivest},
|
---|
3494 | title = {Introduction to Algorithms},
|
---|
3495 | publisher = {MIT Press/McGraw-Hill},
|
---|
3496 | address = {Cambridge},
|
---|
3497 | series = {Electrical Engineering and Computer Science Series},
|
---|
3498 | year = 1992,
|
---|
3499 | }
|
---|
3500 |
|
---|
3501 | @book{Hopcroft79,
|
---|
3502 | keywords = {finite-state machine, push-dowm automata},
|
---|
3503 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3504 | author = {John E. Hopcroft and Jeffrey D. Ullman},
|
---|
3505 | title = {Introduction to Automata Theory, Languages and Computation},
|
---|
3506 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
3507 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
3508 | year = 1979,
|
---|
3509 | }
|
---|
3510 |
|
---|
3511 | @techreport{walker87,
|
---|
3512 | keywords = {CCS},
|
---|
3513 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3514 | author = {David Walker},
|
---|
3515 | title = {Introduction to a Calculus of Communicating Systems},
|
---|
3516 | institution = {Laboratory for Foundations of Computer Science},
|
---|
3517 | year = 1987,
|
---|
3518 | address = {Department of Computer Science, University of Edinburgh, Edinburgh EH9 3JZ},
|
---|
3519 | month = jun,
|
---|
3520 | number = {ECS-LFCS-87-22},
|
---|
3521 | }
|
---|
3522 |
|
---|
3523 | @article{katzenelson83a,
|
---|
3524 | author = {Jacob Katzenelson},
|
---|
3525 | title = {Introduction to Enhanced C (EC)},
|
---|
3526 | journal = spe,
|
---|
3527 | volume = 13,
|
---|
3528 | number = 7,
|
---|
3529 | year = 1983,
|
---|
3530 | month = jul,
|
---|
3531 | pages = {551-576},
|
---|
3532 | }
|
---|
3533 |
|
---|
3534 | @book{Deitel90,
|
---|
3535 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems},
|
---|
3536 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3537 | author = {Harvey M. Deitel},
|
---|
3538 | title = {An Introduction to Operating Systems},
|
---|
3539 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
3540 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
3541 | year = 1990,
|
---|
3542 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
3543 | }
|
---|
3544 |
|
---|
3545 | @techreport{Birrell89,
|
---|
3546 | keywords = {threads, monitors},
|
---|
3547 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3548 | author = {Andrew D. Birrell},
|
---|
3549 | title = {An Introduction to Programming with Threads},
|
---|
3550 | institution = {Digital Systems Research Center},
|
---|
3551 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, California, 94301},
|
---|
3552 | number = {35},
|
---|
3553 | month = jan,
|
---|
3554 | year = 1989,
|
---|
3555 | note = {{\textsf{http://www.hpl.hp.com/\-techreports/\-Compaq-DEC/\-SRC-RR-35.html}}},
|
---|
3556 |
|
---|
3557 | }
|
---|
3558 |
|
---|
3559 | @article{t/o,
|
---|
3560 | keywords = {Trellis/Owl},
|
---|
3561 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3562 | author = {Craig Schaffert and Topher Cooper and Bruce Bullis and Mike Kilian and Carrie Wilpot},
|
---|
3563 | title = {An Introduction to Trellis/Owl},
|
---|
3564 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
3565 | volume = 21,
|
---|
3566 | number = 11,
|
---|
3567 | year = 1986,
|
---|
3568 | month = nov,
|
---|
3569 | pages = {9-16},
|
---|
3570 | }
|
---|
3571 |
|
---|
3572 | @inproceedings{Hibbard77,
|
---|
3573 | keywords = {algol-68, concurrency},
|
---|
3574 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3575 | author = {Peter G. Hibbard and P. Knueven and B. W. Leverett},
|
---|
3576 | title = {Issues in the Efficient Implementation and Use of Multiprocessing in {Algol} 68},
|
---|
3577 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 5th Annual iii Conference},
|
---|
3578 | address = {Guidel, France},
|
---|
3579 | month = may,
|
---|
3580 | year = 1977,
|
---|
3581 | pages = {203-221}
|
---|
3582 | }
|
---|
3583 |
|
---|
3584 | @inproceedings{Miller97,
|
---|
3585 | keywords = {exception handling, software-engineering},
|
---|
3586 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3587 | author = {Robert Miller and Anand Tripathi},
|
---|
3588 | title = {Issues with Exception Hnadling in Object-Oriented Systems},
|
---|
3589 | booktitle = {ECOOP'97},
|
---|
3590 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
3591 | volume = 1241,
|
---|
3592 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
3593 | year = 1997,
|
---|
3594 | pages = {85-103}
|
---|
3595 | }
|
---|
3596 |
|
---|
3597 | @article{Murer96,
|
---|
3598 | keywords = {interators, generators, cursors},
|
---|
3599 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3600 | author = {Stephan Murer and Stephen Omohundro and David Stoutamire and Clemens Szyperski},
|
---|
3601 | title = {Iteration Abstraction in Sather},
|
---|
3602 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
3603 | month = jan,
|
---|
3604 | year = 1996,
|
---|
3605 | volume = 18,
|
---|
3606 | number = 1,
|
---|
3607 | pages = {1-15},
|
---|
3608 | }
|
---|
3609 |
|
---|
3610 | % J
|
---|
3611 |
|
---|
3612 | @book{Java,
|
---|
3613 | keywords = {Java},
|
---|
3614 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3615 | author = {James Gosling and Bill Joy and Guy Steele and Gilad Bracha},
|
---|
3616 | title = {The {Java} Language Specification},
|
---|
3617 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
3618 | address = {Reading},
|
---|
3619 | year = 2000,
|
---|
3620 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
3621 | }
|
---|
3622 |
|
---|
3623 | @manual{Java8,
|
---|
3624 | keywords = {Java SE 8},
|
---|
3625 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3626 | author = {James Gosling and Bill Joy and Guy Steele and Gilad Bracha and Alex Buckley},
|
---|
3627 | title = {The {Java} Language Specification},
|
---|
3628 | publisher = {Oracle},
|
---|
3629 | year = 2015,
|
---|
3630 | edition = {Java SE 8},
|
---|
3631 | }
|
---|
3632 |
|
---|
3633 | @manual{JUC,
|
---|
3634 | keywords = {Java concurrency library},
|
---|
3635 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3636 | title = {java.util.concurrency},
|
---|
3637 | author = {Doug Lea},
|
---|
3638 | organization= {Oracle},
|
---|
3639 | year = 2014,
|
---|
3640 | note = {\href{http://docs.oracle.com/javase/7/docs/api/java/util/concurrent/package-summary.html}{\textsf{http://docs.oracle.com/\-javase/7/\-docs/\-api/\-java/\-util/\-concurrent/\-package-summary.html}}},
|
---|
3641 | }
|
---|
3642 |
|
---|
3643 | % K
|
---|
3644 |
|
---|
3645 | @article{Duggan96,
|
---|
3646 | keywords = {concurrency, critical section},
|
---|
3647 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3648 | author = {Dominic Duggan and Gordon V. Cormack and John Ophel},
|
---|
3649 | title = {Kinded Type Inference for Parametric Overloading},
|
---|
3650 | journal = acta,
|
---|
3651 | volume = 33,
|
---|
3652 | number = 1,
|
---|
3653 | year = 1996,
|
---|
3654 | pages = {21-68},
|
---|
3655 | }
|
---|
3656 |
|
---|
3657 | @article{Peter35,
|
---|
3658 | keywords = {recursion, Ackermann function},
|
---|
3659 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3660 | author = {R{\'{o}}zsa P{\'{e}}ter},
|
---|
3661 | title = {Konstruktion nichtrekursiver Funktionen},
|
---|
3662 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
3663 | journal = mathann,
|
---|
3664 | number = 111,
|
---|
3665 | volume = 1,
|
---|
3666 | pages = {42-60},
|
---|
3667 | month = dec,
|
---|
3668 | year = 1935,
|
---|
3669 | }
|
---|
3670 |
|
---|
3671 | % L
|
---|
3672 |
|
---|
3673 | @TechReport{WVWR88:L,
|
---|
3674 | contributer = {gjditchf@plg},
|
---|
3675 | author = {Hanno Wupper and Jan Vytopil and Martin Wieczorek and Dick de Reus},
|
---|
3676 | title = {{L}_{3333}: A Simple Language with Static Typing of Hard Real-Time Constraints},
|
---|
3677 | institution = {Department of Informatics, Faculty of Science, Catholic University Nijmegen},
|
---|
3678 | year = 1988,
|
---|
3679 | number = {88-3},
|
---|
3680 | address = {Katholieke Universiteit Nijmegen, Fakulteit der Wiskunde
|
---|
3681 | en Natuurwetenschappen, Infomatica V, Toernooiveld, 6512
|
---|
3682 | ED Nijmegen, The Netherlands},
|
---|
3683 | month = apr,
|
---|
3684 | annote = {A polymorphic typed lambda calculus with \begin{itemize}
|
---|
3685 | \item A trivial type, ``!'', with a single element.
|
---|
3686 | \item Labelled types, distinct from each other.
|
---|
3687 | ``!False'' and ``!True'' are distinct types, each
|
---|
3688 | containing a single value serving as boolean false and
|
---|
3689 | true. ``2'' is an abbreviation for ``!0 succ succ'', the
|
---|
3690 | type containing only 2.
|
---|
3691 | \item Disjunction types ``\{| !False, !True |\}''. Interval
|
---|
3692 | types are abbreviations for disjunctions.
|
---|
3693 | \item Conjunction types ``\{\& real Re, real Im \&\}'', where
|
---|
3694 | ``Re'' and ``Im'' are type labels that distinguish between the
|
---|
3695 | fields.
|
---|
3696 | \item Pair types ``\{^ a, b ^\}'', for use in recursive types
|
---|
3697 | and dyadic infix functions.
|
---|
3698 | \item Function types, universal types, existential types,
|
---|
3699 | and subtyping (viewed as coercion), as in Fun.
|
---|
3700 | \end{itemize}
|
---|
3701 | Disjunctions and conjunctions types are associative and
|
---|
3702 | commutative (i.e. flat). Each type has a matching
|
---|
3703 | constructor. Functions use pattern matching on type
|
---|
3704 | labels to strip labels and extract conjunction fields:
|
---|
3705 | \begin{verbatim}
|
---|
3706 | \lambda n {0...1000000 Guilders}. ... n ...
|
---|
3707 | -- both argument and n are amounts in Guilders.
|
---|
3708 | \lambda n {0...1000000} Guilders. ... n ...
|
---|
3709 | -- argument in Guilders, but n is in 0...1000000.
|
---|
3710 | \end{verbatim}
|
---|
3711 | ``Function bundles'' (conjunctions of functions), applied
|
---|
3712 | to arguments, replace Dijkstra's guarded if...fi, but the
|
---|
3713 | bundles are first-class and the guards are part of their
|
---|
3714 | type.
|
---|
3715 |
|
---|
3716 | The same trick used to define the type ``2'' is used to
|
---|
3717 | move absolute times into the type system, to allow static
|
---|
3718 | checking. ``0`'' denotes a time before the system begins
|
---|
3719 | execution. ``\#`'' denotes ``eventually'', and ``?`''
|
---|
3720 | denotes ``maybe never''. ``a\\t'' and ``a@t'' are types
|
---|
3721 | of a value of type a that will be available no later
|
---|
3722 | (earlier) than time t. Universals and existentials use
|
---|
3723 | subtyping to parameterize functions by start time:
|
---|
3724 | \begin{verbatim}
|
---|
3725 | let f {\forall t > \#`}. {a\t} \on {b\t+d}
|
---|
3726 | f{then} y -- argument y must be available at time ``then''.
|
---|
3727 | \end{verbatim}
|
---|
3728 | Functions can return before their arguments are available
|
---|
3729 | if they don't use them. However, function {\em bundles}
|
---|
3730 | can't return until their result type is known, so the
|
---|
3731 | lower and upper time bounds of the bundle are the
|
---|
3732 | second-last upper bound of the component functions: at
|
---|
3733 | that time, there is only one alternative left.
|
---|
3734 |
|
---|
3735 | Explicit time parameterization allows slack in time
|
---|
3736 | specification. Tools could point out slack or determine
|
---|
3737 | degree of parallelism.}
|
---|
3738 | }
|
---|
3739 |
|
---|
3740 | @mastersthesis{Clarke90,
|
---|
3741 | keywords = {concurrency, postponing requests},
|
---|
3742 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3743 | author = {Charles L. A. Clarke},
|
---|
3744 | title = {Language and Compiler Support for Synchronous Message Passing Architectures},
|
---|
3745 | school = {University of Waterloo},
|
---|
3746 | year = 1990,
|
---|
3747 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}
|
---|
3748 | }
|
---|
3749 |
|
---|
3750 | @article{Tennent77,
|
---|
3751 | keywords = {abstraction, correspondence, Pascal},
|
---|
3752 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3753 | author = {R. D. Tennent},
|
---|
3754 | title = {Language Design Methods Based on Semantic Principles},
|
---|
3755 | journal = acta,
|
---|
3756 | year = 1977,
|
---|
3757 | volume = 8,
|
---|
3758 | number = 2,
|
---|
3759 | pages = {97-112},
|
---|
3760 | note = {reprinted in \cite{pldesign}},
|
---|
3761 | abstract = {
|
---|
3762 | Two language design methods based on principles derived from the
|
---|
3763 | denotational approach to programming language semantics are
|
---|
3764 | described and illustrated by an application to the language Pascal.
|
---|
3765 | The principles are, firstly, the correspondence between parametric
|
---|
3766 | and declarative mechanisms and secondly, a principle of abstraction
|
---|
3767 | for programming languages adapted from set theory. Several useful
|
---|
3768 | extensions and generalizations of Pascal emerge by applying these
|
---|
3769 | principles, including a solution to the array parameter problem,
|
---|
3770 | and a modularization facility.
|
---|
3771 | },
|
---|
3772 | }
|
---|
3773 |
|
---|
3774 | @article{Liskov86,
|
---|
3775 | keywords = {synchronous communication, concurrency},
|
---|
3776 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3777 | author = {Barbara Liskov and Maurice Kerlihy and Lucy Gilbert},
|
---|
3778 | title = {Limitations of Synchronous Communication with Static
|
---|
3779 | Process Structure in Languages for Distributed Computing},
|
---|
3780 | journal = {},
|
---|
3781 | volume = {},
|
---|
3782 | number = {},
|
---|
3783 | month = {},
|
---|
3784 | year = {},
|
---|
3785 | pages = {},
|
---|
3786 | }
|
---|
3787 |
|
---|
3788 | @article{Linda,
|
---|
3789 | keywords = {Linda, concurrency},
|
---|
3790 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3791 | author = {Nicholas Carriero and David Gelernter},
|
---|
3792 | title = {Linda in Context},
|
---|
3793 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
3794 | volume = 32,
|
---|
3795 | number = 4,
|
---|
3796 | month = apr,
|
---|
3797 | year = 1989,
|
---|
3798 | pages = {444-458}
|
---|
3799 | }
|
---|
3800 |
|
---|
3801 | @book{Weissman67,
|
---|
3802 | keywords = {lisp},
|
---|
3803 | author = {Clark Weissman},
|
---|
3804 | title = {Lisp 1.5 Primer},
|
---|
3805 | publisher = {Dickenson Publishing},
|
---|
3806 | address = {Belmont},
|
---|
3807 | year = 1967,
|
---|
3808 | }
|
---|
3809 |
|
---|
3810 | @article{Sundell08,
|
---|
3811 | keywords = {lock free, deque},
|
---|
3812 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3813 | author = {H{\r{a}}kan Sundell and Philippas Tsigas},
|
---|
3814 | title = {Lock-free Deques and Doubly Linked Lists},
|
---|
3815 | journal = {J. Parallel Distrib. Comput.},
|
---|
3816 | volume = 68,
|
---|
3817 | number = 7,
|
---|
3818 | year = 2008,
|
---|
3819 | pages = {1008-1020},
|
---|
3820 | }
|
---|
3821 |
|
---|
3822 | @article{Cormack89,
|
---|
3823 | keywords = {parsing, LR, error recovery},
|
---|
3824 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3825 | author = {Gordon V. Cormack},
|
---|
3826 | title = {An {LR} Substring Parser for Noncorrecting Syntax Error Recovery},
|
---|
3827 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
3828 | volume = 24,
|
---|
3829 | number = 7,
|
---|
3830 | month = jul,
|
---|
3831 | year = 1989,
|
---|
3832 | pages = {161-169},
|
---|
3833 | note = {Proceedings of the {SIGPLAN}~'89 Conference on Programming Language Design and Implementation}
|
---|
3834 | }
|
---|
3835 |
|
---|
3836 | % M
|
---|
3837 |
|
---|
3838 | @book{M68K,
|
---|
3839 | keywords = {M680XX, Motorola},
|
---|
3840 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3841 | key = {Motorola},
|
---|
3842 | title = {M68000 Family Programmer's Reference Manual},
|
---|
3843 | publisher = {Motorola},
|
---|
3844 | year = 1992,
|
---|
3845 | }
|
---|
3846 |
|
---|
3847 | @article{c++libs,
|
---|
3848 | keywords = {directory structure},
|
---|
3849 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3850 | author = {J. M. Coggins and G. Bollella},
|
---|
3851 | title = {Managing {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Libraries},
|
---|
3852 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
3853 | year = 1989,
|
---|
3854 | month = jun, volume = 24, number = 6, pages = {37-48},
|
---|
3855 | abstract = {
|
---|
3856 | This paper describes a scheme we have used to manage a large
|
---|
3857 | library written in the C++ language. The scheme imposes a
|
---|
3858 | directory structure, and represents dependency hierarchy in a
|
---|
3859 | globally accessible file we call the 'prelude' file. We also
|
---|
3860 | discuss the structure of the description files (makefiles) used
|
---|
3861 | with the UNIX options we have found to be useful in reducing the
|
---|
3862 | size of the library, and how to minimize recompilation time after
|
---|
3863 | trivial changes to the source code of the library.
|
---|
3864 | }
|
---|
3865 | }
|
---|
3866 |
|
---|
3867 | @inproceedings{mprof,
|
---|
3868 | keywords = {malloc},
|
---|
3869 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
3870 | author = {Benjamin Zorn and Paul Hilfinger},
|
---|
3871 | title = {A Memory Allocation Profiler for {C} and Lisp Programs},
|
---|
3872 | booktitle = {Summer 1988 {USENIX} proceedings},
|
---|
3873 | year = 1988
|
---|
3874 | }
|
---|
3875 |
|
---|
3876 | @manual{MMTk,
|
---|
3877 | keywords = {Java memory management},
|
---|
3878 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3879 | title = {MMTk: The Memory Management Toolkit},
|
---|
3880 | author = {Steve Blackburn and Robin Garner and Daniel Frampton},
|
---|
3881 | month = sep,
|
---|
3882 | year = 2006,
|
---|
3883 | note = {\textsf{http://cs.anu.edu.au/\-\char`\~Robin.Garner/\-mmtk-guide.pdf}},
|
---|
3884 | }
|
---|
3885 |
|
---|
3886 | @article{Adve10,
|
---|
3887 | keywords = {Java memory management},
|
---|
3888 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3889 | author = {Sarita V. Adve and Hans-J. Boehm},
|
---|
3890 | title = {Memory Models: A Case for Rethinking Parallel Languages and Hardware},
|
---|
3891 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
3892 | volume = 53,
|
---|
3893 | number = 8,
|
---|
3894 | month = aug,
|
---|
3895 | year = 2010,
|
---|
3896 | pages = {90-101},
|
---|
3897 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
3898 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
3899 | }
|
---|
3900 | @techreport{Mesa,
|
---|
3901 | keywords = {monitors, packages},
|
---|
3902 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3903 | author = {James G. Mitchell and William Maybury and Richard Sweet},
|
---|
3904 | title = {Mesa Language Manual},
|
---|
3905 | institution = {Xerox Palo Alto Research Center},
|
---|
3906 | number = {CSL--79--3},
|
---|
3907 | month = apr,
|
---|
3908 | year = 1979
|
---|
3909 | }
|
---|
3910 |
|
---|
3911 | @article{Andrews89,
|
---|
3912 | keywords = {semaphore, split-binary, baton},
|
---|
3913 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3914 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews},
|
---|
3915 | title = {A Method for Solving Synronization Problems},
|
---|
3916 | journal = scp,
|
---|
3917 | volume = 13,
|
---|
3918 | number = 4,
|
---|
3919 | month = dec,
|
---|
3920 | year = 1989,
|
---|
3921 | pages = {1-21},
|
---|
3922 | }
|
---|
3923 |
|
---|
3924 | @inproceedings{Mitchell78,
|
---|
3925 | keywords = {Mesa},
|
---|
3926 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3927 | author = {James G. Mitchell},
|
---|
3928 | title = {Mesa: A Designer's User Perspective},
|
---|
3929 | booktitle = {Spring CompCom 78},
|
---|
3930 | organization= {Sixteenth IEEE Computer Society International Conference},
|
---|
3931 | address = {San Francisco, California, U.S.A.},
|
---|
3932 | month = feb,
|
---|
3933 | year = 1978,
|
---|
3934 | pages = {36-39},
|
---|
3935 | note = {IEEE Catalog No. 78CH1328-4C},
|
---|
3936 | }
|
---|
3937 |
|
---|
3938 | @article{Gentleman81,
|
---|
3939 | keywords = {messages, concurrency},
|
---|
3940 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3941 | author = {W. Morven Gentleman},
|
---|
3942 | title = {Message Passing between Sequential Processes:
|
---|
3943 | the Reply Primitive and the Administrator Concept},
|
---|
3944 | journal = spe,
|
---|
3945 | month = may,
|
---|
3946 | year = 1981,
|
---|
3947 | volume = 11,
|
---|
3948 | number = 5,
|
---|
3949 | pages = {435-466}
|
---|
3950 | }
|
---|
3951 |
|
---|
3952 | @article{Cormack88,
|
---|
3953 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
3954 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3955 | author = {G. V. Cormack},
|
---|
3956 | title = {A Micro Kernel for Concurrency in C},
|
---|
3957 | journal = spe,
|
---|
3958 | month = may,
|
---|
3959 | year = 1988,
|
---|
3960 | volume = 18,
|
---|
3961 | number = 4,
|
---|
3962 | pages = {485-491}
|
---|
3963 | }
|
---|
3964 |
|
---|
3965 | @article{Buhr90a,
|
---|
3966 | keywords = {concurrency, light-weight process, shared memory},
|
---|
3967 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3968 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Richard A. Stroobosscher},
|
---|
3969 | title = {The $\mu${S}ystem: Providing Light-Weight Concurrency on Shared-Memory Multiprocessor Computers Running {UNIX}},
|
---|
3970 | journal = spe,
|
---|
3971 | volume = 20,
|
---|
3972 | number = 9,
|
---|
3973 | month = sep,
|
---|
3974 | year = 1990,
|
---|
3975 | pages = {929-963},
|
---|
3976 | }
|
---|
3977 |
|
---|
3978 | @techreport{uSystem,
|
---|
3979 | keywords = {C, concurrency, light-weight process, shared memory},
|
---|
3980 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
3981 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Hamish I. Macdonald and Richard A. Stroobosscher},
|
---|
3982 | title = {$\mu${S}ystem Annotated Reference Manual, Version 4.4.3},
|
---|
3983 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
3984 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
3985 | month = sep,
|
---|
3986 | year = 1994,
|
---|
3987 | note = {{\small\textsf{ftp://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-pub/\-uSystem/\-uSystem.ps.gz}}},
|
---|
3988 | }
|
---|
3989 |
|
---|
3990 | @book{Mips4000,
|
---|
3991 | key = {Mips4000},
|
---|
3992 | title = {MIPS R4000 Microprocessor User's Manual},
|
---|
3993 | publisher = {MIPS Computer Systems Inc},
|
---|
3994 | year = 1991,
|
---|
3995 | }
|
---|
3996 |
|
---|
3997 | @inproceedings{Mjolner,
|
---|
3998 | keywords = {Mjolner, hierarchical windows},
|
---|
3999 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4000 | author = {G\"{o}rel Hedin and Boris Magnusson},
|
---|
4001 | title = {The Mj{\o}lner Environment: Direct Interaction with Abstractions},
|
---|
4002 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the European Conference on Object Oriented Programming},
|
---|
4003 | organization= {ECOOP'88},
|
---|
4004 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
4005 | volume = 322,
|
---|
4006 | editor = {S. Gjessing and K. Nygaard},
|
---|
4007 | address = {Oslo, Norway},
|
---|
4008 | month = aug,
|
---|
4009 | year = 1988,
|
---|
4010 | pages = {41-54},
|
---|
4011 | note = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science, Ed. by G. Goos and J. Hartmanis},
|
---|
4012 | }
|
---|
4013 |
|
---|
4014 | @article{Skillicorn98,
|
---|
4015 | keywords = {parallel models},
|
---|
4016 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4017 | author = {David B. Skillicorn and Domenico Talia},
|
---|
4018 | title = {Models and Languages for Parallel Computation},
|
---|
4019 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
4020 | volume = 30,
|
---|
4021 | number = 2,
|
---|
4022 | month = jun,
|
---|
4023 | year = 1998,
|
---|
4024 | pages = {123-169},
|
---|
4025 | }
|
---|
4026 |
|
---|
4027 | @article{Werther96,
|
---|
4028 | keywords = {C++, language syntax},
|
---|
4029 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4030 | author = {Ben Werther and Damian Conway},
|
---|
4031 | title = {A Modest Proposal: {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Resyntaxed},
|
---|
4032 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
4033 | volume = 31,
|
---|
4034 | number = 11,
|
---|
4035 | month = nov,
|
---|
4036 | year = 1996,
|
---|
4037 | pages = {74-82},
|
---|
4038 | }
|
---|
4039 |
|
---|
4040 | @book{Alexandrescu01,
|
---|
4041 | keywords = {c design-patterns programming},
|
---|
4042 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4043 | author = {Andrei Alexandrescu},
|
---|
4044 | title = {Modern C++ Design: Generic Programming and Design Patterns Applied},
|
---|
4045 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley Professional},
|
---|
4046 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
4047 | month = feb,
|
---|
4048 | year = 2001,
|
---|
4049 | isbn = {0201704315},
|
---|
4050 | }
|
---|
4051 |
|
---|
4052 | @book{Tanenbaum92,
|
---|
4053 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems},
|
---|
4054 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4055 | author = {Andrew S. Tanenbaum},
|
---|
4056 | title = {Modern Operating Systems},
|
---|
4057 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
4058 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
4059 | year = 1992,
|
---|
4060 | }
|
---|
4061 |
|
---|
4062 | @article{Wirth77,
|
---|
4063 | keywords = {modules, coroutines},
|
---|
4064 | contributer = {pabuhr},
|
---|
4065 | author = {Niklaus Wirth},
|
---|
4066 | title = {Modula: a Language for Modular Multiprogramming},
|
---|
4067 | journal = spe,
|
---|
4068 | month = {January--February},
|
---|
4069 | year = 1977,
|
---|
4070 | volume = 7,
|
---|
4071 | number = 1,
|
---|
4072 | pages = {3-35},
|
---|
4073 | }
|
---|
4074 |
|
---|
4075 | @book{Harbison92,
|
---|
4076 | contributer = {mhcoffin},
|
---|
4077 | author = {Samuel P. Harbison},
|
---|
4078 | title = {Modula-3},
|
---|
4079 | publisher = {Prentise Hall, Inc.},
|
---|
4080 | year = {1992},
|
---|
4081 | comment = {This is a textbook for learning Modula-3.}
|
---|
4082 | }
|
---|
4083 |
|
---|
4084 | @techreport{Modula-3:old,
|
---|
4085 | keywords = {Modula-3, inheritance, type extension},
|
---|
4086 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4087 | author = {Luca Cardelli and James Donahue and Lucille Glassman and Mick
|
---|
4088 | Jordan and Bill Kalsow and Greg Nelson},
|
---|
4089 | title = {Modula-3 Report},
|
---|
4090 | institution = {Systems Research Center},
|
---|
4091 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, California 94301},
|
---|
4092 | month = aug,
|
---|
4093 | year = 1988,
|
---|
4094 | number = 31
|
---|
4095 | }
|
---|
4096 |
|
---|
4097 | @article{Dueck90,
|
---|
4098 | keywords = {attribute grammars},
|
---|
4099 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4100 | author = {Gerald D. P. Dueck and Gordon V. Cormack},
|
---|
4101 | title = {Modular Attribute Grammars},
|
---|
4102 | journal = {The Computer Journal},
|
---|
4103 | month = apr,
|
---|
4104 | year = 1990,
|
---|
4105 | volume = 33,
|
---|
4106 | number = 2,
|
---|
4107 | pages = {164-172},
|
---|
4108 | }
|
---|
4109 |
|
---|
4110 | @article{Yemini85,
|
---|
4111 | keywords = {exception handling},
|
---|
4112 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4113 | author = {Shaula Yemini and Daniel M. Berry},
|
---|
4114 | title = {A Modular Verifiable Exception-Handling Mechanism},
|
---|
4115 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
4116 | month = apr,
|
---|
4117 | year = 1985,
|
---|
4118 | volume = 7,
|
---|
4119 | number = 2,
|
---|
4120 | pages = {214-243},
|
---|
4121 | }
|
---|
4122 |
|
---|
4123 | @article{Buhr95b,
|
---|
4124 | keywords = {concurrency, monitors, classification},
|
---|
4125 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4126 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Michel Fortier and Michael H. Coffin},
|
---|
4127 | title = {Monitor Classification},
|
---|
4128 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
4129 | volume = 27,
|
---|
4130 | number = 1,
|
---|
4131 | month = mar,
|
---|
4132 | year = 1995,
|
---|
4133 | pages = {63-107},
|
---|
4134 | }
|
---|
4135 |
|
---|
4136 | @article{Hoare74,
|
---|
4137 | keywords = {monitor},
|
---|
4138 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4139 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare},
|
---|
4140 | title = {Monitors: An Operating System Structuring Concept},
|
---|
4141 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
4142 | volume = 17,
|
---|
4143 | number = 10,
|
---|
4144 | month = oct,
|
---|
4145 | year = 1974,
|
---|
4146 | pages = {549-557},
|
---|
4147 | annote = {
|
---|
4148 | }
|
---|
4149 | }
|
---|
4150 |
|
---|
4151 | @inbook{Buhr99a,
|
---|
4152 | keywords = {concurrency, monitors, classification},
|
---|
4153 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4154 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Michel Fortier and Michael H. Coffin},
|
---|
4155 | title = {Encyclopedia of Computer Science and Technology},
|
---|
4156 | chapter = {Monitor Taxonomy},
|
---|
4157 | publisher = {Marcel Dekker, Inc},
|
---|
4158 | volume = {40, supplement 25},
|
---|
4159 | year = 1999,
|
---|
4160 | pages = {191-212},
|
---|
4161 | }
|
---|
4162 | % editor = {Allen Kent and James G. Williams},
|
---|
4163 |
|
---|
4164 | @manual{MPI,
|
---|
4165 | keywords = {MPI},
|
---|
4166 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4167 | title = {MPI: A Message-Passing Interface Standard, Version 3.1},
|
---|
4168 | organization= {Message Passing Interface Forum},
|
---|
4169 | address = {University of Tennessee, Knoxville, Tennessee},
|
---|
4170 | month = jun,
|
---|
4171 | year = 2015,
|
---|
4172 | note = {\href{http://www.mpi-forum.org/docs/mpi-3.1/mpi31-report.pdf}{\textsf{http://www.mpi-forum.org/\-docs/\-mpi-3.1/\-mpi31-report.pdf}}},
|
---|
4173 | }
|
---|
4174 |
|
---|
4175 | @article{multilisp,
|
---|
4176 | keywords = {futures, scheme},
|
---|
4177 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4178 | author = {Halstead, Jr.,Robert H.},
|
---|
4179 | title = {Multilisp: A Language for Concurrent Symbolic Programming},
|
---|
4180 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
4181 | volume = 7,
|
---|
4182 | number = 4,
|
---|
4183 | pages = {501-538},
|
---|
4184 | month = oct,
|
---|
4185 | year = 1985,
|
---|
4186 | comment = {
|
---|
4187 | (future E) begins evaluating the expression E, and
|
---|
4188 | returns a ``future'' representing the value. When evaluation is
|
---|
4189 | finished, the value of E replaces the future. Operations that need
|
---|
4190 | the future's value suspend until it is available. Assignment and
|
---|
4191 | parameter passing do not suspend. Future introduces concurrency
|
---|
4192 | between the calculation of a value and its use; reference to
|
---|
4193 | futures is a synchronization mechanism.
|
---|
4194 |
|
---|
4195 | (pcall F A B ... C) concurrently evaluates F, A, B, ... C, and then
|
---|
4196 | applies F to the arguments. pcall can be built from future and a
|
---|
4197 | ``touch'' operation. pcall is included because it may not be easy
|
---|
4198 | to determine that there are no critical sections between the future
|
---|
4199 | expression and the code between the future call and the value's
|
---|
4200 | first use.
|
---|
4201 |
|
---|
4202 | (delay E) is like future, but E's process does not begin until its
|
---|
4203 | value is needed. It provides lazy evaluation. Replacing delay
|
---|
4204 | with future would launch an infinite number of processes.
|
---|
4205 | }
|
---|
4206 | }
|
---|
4207 |
|
---|
4208 | @techreport{Bretthauer89,
|
---|
4209 | keywords = {multiple inheritance},
|
---|
4210 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4211 | author = {Harry Bretthauer and Thomas Christaller and J\"{u}rgen Kopp},
|
---|
4212 | title = {Multiple vs. Single Inheritance in Object-oriented Programming Languages. What do we really want?},
|
---|
4213 | institution = {Gesellschaft F\"{u}r Mathematik und Datenverarbeitung mbH},
|
---|
4214 | address = {Schlo$\beta$ Birlinghoven, Postfach 12 40, D-5205 Sankt Augustin 1, Deutschland},
|
---|
4215 | number = {Arbeitspapiere der GMD 415},
|
---|
4216 | month = nov,
|
---|
4217 | year = 1989,
|
---|
4218 | }
|
---|
4219 |
|
---|
4220 | @inproceedings{c++:multinh,
|
---|
4221 | keywords = {C++, multiple inheritance, implementation},
|
---|
4222 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4223 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
4224 | title = {Multiple Inheritance for {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
4225 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Spring '87 EUUG Conference},
|
---|
4226 | month = may, year = 1987
|
---|
4227 | }
|
---|
4228 |
|
---|
4229 | @inproceedings{st:mult,
|
---|
4230 | keywords = {smalltalk, multiple inheritance, implementation},
|
---|
4231 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4232 | author = {Daniel H. H. Ingalls and A. H. Borning},
|
---|
4233 | title = {Multiple Inheritance in Smalltalk-80},
|
---|
4234 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the National Conference on Artificial Intelligence},
|
---|
4235 | month = aug,
|
---|
4236 | year = 1982,
|
---|
4237 | pages = {234-238},
|
---|
4238 | organization= {American Association for Artificial Intelligence},
|
---|
4239 | comment = {
|
---|
4240 | Methods are looked up in the current class, the superclasses, the
|
---|
4241 | supersuperclasses, etc. The same method can be inherited
|
---|
4242 | repeatedly, but having different methods for the same message is an
|
---|
4243 | error. Only one copy is made for multiply-inherited fields.
|
---|
4244 |
|
---|
4245 | {\tt X.m} is the method m in superclass X. {\tt super.m} is
|
---|
4246 | allowed if there is no ambiguity; {\tt self super.m} replaces {\tt
|
---|
4247 | super m}. {\tt all.m} invokes all inherited versions of m.
|
---|
4248 |
|
---|
4249 | Methods on the first-superclass chain are found as usual. Methods
|
---|
4250 | from other superclasses are copied into the class dictionary. An
|
---|
4251 | error method is created if inherited methods conflict. The parser
|
---|
4252 | is changed to allow compound selectors. {\tt Object
|
---|
4253 | messageNotUnderstood} is changed to look for compound selectors and
|
---|
4254 | dynamically add a method with the right name and body to the class.
|
---|
4255 | When methods are edited, they are copied into subclasses and
|
---|
4256 | compound selector versions are deleted, as appropriate.
|
---|
4257 | }
|
---|
4258 | }
|
---|
4259 |
|
---|
4260 | @article{Lamport86I,
|
---|
4261 | keywords = {software solutions, N-thread, mutual exclusions},
|
---|
4262 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4263 | author = {Leslie Lamport},
|
---|
4264 | title = {The Mutual Exclusion Problem: Part\,{I}--A Theory of Interprocess Communication},
|
---|
4265 | journal = jacm,
|
---|
4266 | volume = 33,
|
---|
4267 | number = 2,
|
---|
4268 | month = apr,
|
---|
4269 | year = 1986,
|
---|
4270 | pages = {313--326},
|
---|
4271 | numpages = {14},
|
---|
4272 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
4273 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
4274 | }
|
---|
4275 |
|
---|
4276 | @article{Lamport86II,
|
---|
4277 | keywords = {software solutions, N-thread, mutual exclusions},
|
---|
4278 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4279 | author = {Leslie Lamport},
|
---|
4280 | title = {The Mutual Exclusion Problem: Part\,{II}--Statement and Solutions},
|
---|
4281 | journal = jacm,
|
---|
4282 | volume = 33,
|
---|
4283 | number = 2,
|
---|
4284 | month = apr,
|
---|
4285 | year = 1986,
|
---|
4286 | pages = {327--348},
|
---|
4287 | numpages = {22},
|
---|
4288 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
4289 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
4290 | }
|
---|
4291 |
|
---|
4292 | @article{Burns78,
|
---|
4293 | keywords = {hardware, N-process solution, O(N)},
|
---|
4294 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4295 | author = {James E. Burns},
|
---|
4296 | title = {Mutual Exclusion with Linear Waiting Using Binary Shared Variables},
|
---|
4297 | journal = {SIGACT News},
|
---|
4298 | volume = 10,
|
---|
4299 | number = 2,
|
---|
4300 | month = {Summer},
|
---|
4301 | year = 1978,
|
---|
4302 | pages = {42-47},
|
---|
4303 | }
|
---|
4304 |
|
---|
4305 | @inproceedings{Burns80,
|
---|
4306 | keywords = {N-process software solution},
|
---|
4307 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4308 | author = {James E. Burns and Nancy A. Lynch},
|
---|
4309 | title = {Mutual Exclusion using Indivisible Reads and Writes},
|
---|
4310 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 18th Annual Allerton Conference on Communications, Control and Computing, Monticello, Illinois, USA},
|
---|
4311 | year = 1980,
|
---|
4312 | pages = {833-842},
|
---|
4313 | note = {\href{http://groups.csail.mit.edu/tds/papers/Lynch/allertonconf.pdf}{\textsf{http://\-groups.csail.mit.edu/\-tds/\-papers/\-Lynch/\-allertonconf.pdf}} [Accessed on March 2014]},
|
---|
4314 | optnote = {\textsf{http://\-groups.csail.mit.edu/\-tds/\-papers/\-Lynch/\-allertonconf.pdf}},
|
---|
4315 | }
|
---|
4316 |
|
---|
4317 | @article{Peterson81,
|
---|
4318 | keywords = {concurrency, critical section},
|
---|
4319 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4320 | author = {G. L. Peterson},
|
---|
4321 | title = {Myths About the Mutual Exclusion Problem},
|
---|
4322 | journal = ipl,
|
---|
4323 | year = 1981,
|
---|
4324 | month = jun,
|
---|
4325 | volume = 12,
|
---|
4326 | number = 3,
|
---|
4327 | pages = {115-116},
|
---|
4328 | }
|
---|
4329 |
|
---|
4330 | % N
|
---|
4331 |
|
---|
4332 | @article{Haddon77,
|
---|
4333 | keywords = {monitors, nested monitor calls},
|
---|
4334 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4335 | author = {Bruce K. Haddon},
|
---|
4336 | title = {Nested Monitor Calls},
|
---|
4337 | journal = osr,
|
---|
4338 | volume = 11,
|
---|
4339 | number = 4,
|
---|
4340 | month = oct,
|
---|
4341 | year = 1977,
|
---|
4342 | pages = {18-23},
|
---|
4343 | }
|
---|
4344 |
|
---|
4345 | @inproceedings{nesting,
|
---|
4346 | keywords = {},
|
---|
4347 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4348 | author = {Lori A. Clarke and Jack C. Wilenden and Alexander L. Wolf},
|
---|
4349 | title = {Nesting in {Ada} Programs is for the Birds},
|
---|
4350 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the ACM-SIGPLAN Symposium on the {Ada}
|
---|
4351 | Programming Language},
|
---|
4352 | year = 1980,
|
---|
4353 | month = dec, pages = {139-145},
|
---|
4354 | note = {SIGPLAN Notices, v. 15, n. 11},
|
---|
4355 | abstract = {
|
---|
4356 | Given a data abstraction construct like the Ada package and in the
|
---|
4357 | light of current thoughts on programming methodology, we feel that
|
---|
4358 | nesting is an anachronism. In this paper we propose a nest-free
|
---|
4359 | program style for Ada that eschews nested program units and
|
---|
4360 | declarations within blocks and instead heavily utilizes packages
|
---|
4361 | and context specifications as mechanisms for controlling
|
---|
4362 | visibility. We view this proposal as a first step toward the
|
---|
4363 | development of programming methods that exploit the novel language
|
---|
4364 | features available in Ada. Consideration of this proposal's
|
---|
4365 | ramifications for data flow, control flow, and overall program
|
---|
4366 | structure substantiates our contention that a tree structure is
|
---|
4367 | seldom a natural representation of a program and that nesting
|
---|
4368 | therefore generally interferes with program development and
|
---|
4369 | readability.
|
---|
4370 | }
|
---|
4371 | }
|
---|
4372 |
|
---|
4373 | @inproceedings{Buhr88,
|
---|
4374 | keywords = {nested classes, persistence},
|
---|
4375 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4376 | author = {P. A. Buhr and C. R. Zarnke},
|
---|
4377 | title = {Nesting in an Object Oriented Language is NOT for the Birds},
|
---|
4378 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the European Conference on Object Oriented Programming},
|
---|
4379 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
4380 | volume = 322,
|
---|
4381 | editor = {S. Gjessing and K. Nygaard},
|
---|
4382 | address = {Oslo, Norway},
|
---|
4383 | month = aug,
|
---|
4384 | year = 1988,
|
---|
4385 | pages = {128-145},
|
---|
4386 | note = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science, Ed. by G. Goos and J. Hartmanis},
|
---|
4387 | }
|
---|
4388 |
|
---|
4389 | @inproceedings{Thompson90new,
|
---|
4390 | keywords = {Plan 9},
|
---|
4391 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4392 | title = {A New C Compiler},
|
---|
4393 | author = {Ken Thompson},
|
---|
4394 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Summer 1990 UKUUG Conference},
|
---|
4395 | year = 1990,
|
---|
4396 | pages = {41--51},
|
---|
4397 | url = {http://doc.cat-v.org/bell_labs/new_c_compilers/new_c_compiler.pdf}
|
---|
4398 | }
|
---|
4399 |
|
---|
4400 | @article{Trono94,
|
---|
4401 | author = {John A. Trono},
|
---|
4402 | title = {A New Exercise in Concurrency},
|
---|
4403 | journal = {SIGCSE Bulletin},
|
---|
4404 | volume = {26},
|
---|
4405 | number = {3},
|
---|
4406 | month = sep,
|
---|
4407 | year = {1994},
|
---|
4408 | pages = {8-10},
|
---|
4409 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
4410 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
4411 | }
|
---|
4412 |
|
---|
4413 | @article{Lamport74,
|
---|
4414 | keywords = {concurrency, N-Process solution, O(N)},
|
---|
4415 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4416 | author = {Leslie Lamport},
|
---|
4417 | title = {A New Solution of Dijkstra's Concurrent Programming Problem},
|
---|
4418 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
4419 | month = aug,
|
---|
4420 | year = 1974,
|
---|
4421 | volume = 17,
|
---|
4422 | number = 8,
|
---|
4423 | pages = {453-455},
|
---|
4424 | }
|
---|
4425 |
|
---|
4426 | @article{landin,
|
---|
4427 | keywords = {},
|
---|
4428 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4429 | author = {P. J. Landin},
|
---|
4430 | title = {The Next 700 Programing Languages},
|
---|
4431 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
4432 | year = 1966,
|
---|
4433 | volume = 9,
|
---|
4434 | pages = {157-164},
|
---|
4435 | }
|
---|
4436 |
|
---|
4437 | @article{Herlihy05,
|
---|
4438 | keywords = {Multiprocessors, concurrent data structures, dynamic data structures, memory management, nonblocking synchronization},
|
---|
4439 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4440 | author = {Maurice Herlihy and Victor Luchangco and Paul Martin and Mark Moir},
|
---|
4441 | title = {Nonblocking Memory Management Support for Dynamic-sized Data Structures},
|
---|
4442 | journal = tocs,
|
---|
4443 | volume = 23,
|
---|
4444 | number = 2,
|
---|
4445 | month = may,
|
---|
4446 | year = 2005,
|
---|
4447 | pages = {146-196},
|
---|
4448 | numpages = {51},
|
---|
4449 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
4450 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
4451 | }
|
---|
4452 |
|
---|
4453 | % O
|
---|
4454 |
|
---|
4455 | @inproceedings{oop:abcl/1,
|
---|
4456 | keywords = {concurrency, OOPL, futures},
|
---|
4457 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4458 | author = {Akinori Yonezawa and Jean-Pierre Briot and Etsuya Shibayama},
|
---|
4459 | title = {Object-Oriented Concurrent Programming in {ABCL/1}},
|
---|
4460 | crossref = "OOPSLA86",
|
---|
4461 | pages = {258-268},
|
---|
4462 | comment = {
|
---|
4463 | Actions for messages sent to an object are executed concurrently
|
---|
4464 | iff the object has no members. A select construct specifies a set
|
---|
4465 | of message patterns.
|
---|
4466 |
|
---|
4467 | Express messages have priority. If an express message arrives
|
---|
4468 | while an ordinary message is being processed, the action for the
|
---|
4469 | ordinary message is suspended or aborted and the action for the
|
---|
4470 | express message is executed. The sender decides which class a
|
---|
4471 | message belongs in. Non-interruptible sections can be defined.
|
---|
4472 |
|
---|
4473 | Message sends can be non-blocking, or can block until a reply is
|
---|
4474 | received, at the sender's option. The receiver can continue to
|
---|
4475 | execute after sending the reply.
|
---|
4476 |
|
---|
4477 | Replies can send back ``futures'', and put values in them later.
|
---|
4478 | Futures are queues of values, not single values. The caller can
|
---|
4479 | use a ``ready?'' predicate to test for empty queue, or can use
|
---|
4480 | operations to get the first or all queue elements; these operations
|
---|
4481 | block if the queue is empty.
|
---|
4482 | }
|
---|
4483 | }
|
---|
4484 |
|
---|
4485 | @techreport{Schmidt95,
|
---|
4486 | keywords = {ACE, concurrency, library},
|
---|
4487 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4488 | author = {Douglas C. Schmidt},
|
---|
4489 | title = {An OO Encapsulation of Lightweight OS Concurrency Mechanisms in the {ACE} Toolkit},
|
---|
4490 | institution = {Washington University in St. Louis},
|
---|
4491 | year = 1995,
|
---|
4492 | number = 31,
|
---|
4493 | note = {{\small\textsf{http://\-www.cs.wustl.edu/\-\char`\~schmidt/\-PDF/\-IPC\_SAP-92.pdf}}},
|
---|
4494 | }
|
---|
4495 |
|
---|
4496 | @inproceedings{OOEx,
|
---|
4497 | keywords = {Exceptions, object-oriented programming languages},
|
---|
4498 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4499 | author = {Christophe Dony},
|
---|
4500 | title = {An Object-oriented Exception Handling System for an Object-oriented Language},
|
---|
4501 | booktitle = {ECOOP '88. European Conference on Object-Oriented Programming},
|
---|
4502 | year = 1988,
|
---|
4503 | pages = {146-161},
|
---|
4504 | editor = {S. Gjessing and K. Nygaard},
|
---|
4505 | organization= {DND, The Norwegian Computer Society},
|
---|
4506 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
4507 | comment = {
|
---|
4508 | Objectives:
|
---|
4509 | - Users can define new exceptions.
|
---|
4510 | - Default handlers can be attached to exceptions.
|
---|
4511 | - Handlers can be attached to classes.
|
---|
4512 | - Handlers can be attached to dynamic entities (expressions).
|
---|
4513 | - Exceptions propagate first along the invocation chain.
|
---|
4514 | - Exceptions should be hierarchically organized classes.
|
---|
4515 | - Handlers should take into account the exception hierarchy (i.e.,
|
---|
4516 | should handle raising of sub-exceptions).
|
---|
4517 | The ``exceptional-event'' class has two subclasses. ``Warning''
|
---|
4518 | has a ``resume'' method, and ``error'' has ``exit'' and
|
---|
4519 | ``retry'' methods. Signalling an exception creates an instance
|
---|
4520 | of the exception, whose members are used to pass information
|
---|
4521 | back to the handler. Handlers are instances of class
|
---|
4522 | ``protect-handler'' with a method ``protect {\em expression}'',
|
---|
4523 | or are methods defined for the class or the exception.
|
---|
4524 | }
|
---|
4525 | }
|
---|
4526 |
|
---|
4527 | @article{CommonObjects,
|
---|
4528 | author = {A. Snyder},
|
---|
4529 | title = {Object-Oriented Programming for Common Lisp},
|
---|
4530 | address = {Palo Alto CA},
|
---|
4531 | year = 1985,
|
---|
4532 | publisher = {Software Technology Laboratory, Hewlett-Packard Laboratories},
|
---|
4533 | journal = {Report ATC-85-1},
|
---|
4534 | }
|
---|
4535 |
|
---|
4536 | @book{objective-c,
|
---|
4537 | keywords = {},
|
---|
4538 | author = {Brad J. Cox},
|
---|
4539 | title = {Object-oriented programming; an evolutionary approach},
|
---|
4540 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
4541 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
4542 | year = 1986
|
---|
4543 | }
|
---|
4544 |
|
---|
4545 | @book{Beta,
|
---|
4546 | keywords = {Beta, object oriented, concurrency, exceptions},
|
---|
4547 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4548 | author = {Ole Lehrmann Madsen and Birger M{\o}ller-Pedersen and Kristen Nygaard},
|
---|
4549 | title = {Object-oriented Programming in the {BETA} Programming Language},
|
---|
4550 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
4551 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
4552 | year = 1993,
|
---|
4553 | }
|
---|
4554 |
|
---|
4555 | @article{Flavors,
|
---|
4556 | author = {D. A. Moon},
|
---|
4557 | title = {Object-Oriented Programming with Flavors},
|
---|
4558 | address = {Portland OR},
|
---|
4559 | month = sep,
|
---|
4560 | year = 1986,
|
---|
4561 | journal = {Proc. ACM Conf. on Object-Oriented Systems, Languages and Applications},
|
---|
4562 | }
|
---|
4563 |
|
---|
4564 | @article{Buhr00b,
|
---|
4565 | keywords = {concurrency, C++, real-time},
|
---|
4566 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4567 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Ashif S. Harji and Philipp E. Lim and Jiongxiong Chen},
|
---|
4568 | title = {Object-Oriented Real-Time Concurrency},
|
---|
4569 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
4570 | volume = 35,
|
---|
4571 | number = 10,
|
---|
4572 | month = oct,
|
---|
4573 | year = 2000,
|
---|
4574 | pages = {29-46},
|
---|
4575 | note = {OOPSLA'00, Oct. 15--19, 2000, Minneapolis, Minnesota, U.S.A.},
|
---|
4576 | }
|
---|
4577 |
|
---|
4578 | @book{Meyer88,
|
---|
4579 | keywords = {Eiffel},
|
---|
4580 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4581 | author = {Bertrand Meyer},
|
---|
4582 | title = {Object-oriented Software Construction},
|
---|
4583 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
4584 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
4585 | year = {1988},
|
---|
4586 | series = {Prentice-Hall International Series in Computer Science},
|
---|
4587 | }
|
---|
4588 |
|
---|
4589 | @article{objectPascal,
|
---|
4590 | keywords = {objects, modules},
|
---|
4591 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4592 | author = {Larry Tesler},
|
---|
4593 | title = {Object Pascal Report},
|
---|
4594 | journal = {Structured Language World},
|
---|
4595 | year = 1985,
|
---|
4596 | volume = 9,
|
---|
4597 | number = 3,
|
---|
4598 | }
|
---|
4599 |
|
---|
4600 | @misc{obj-c:next,
|
---|
4601 | keywords = {categories, protocols, Objective C},
|
---|
4602 | contributor = {gjditchfield@angus},
|
---|
4603 | author = {NeXT Computer, Inc.},
|
---|
4604 | title = {Objective C Extensions},
|
---|
4605 | howpublished= {On-line documentation in ``NEXTSTEP 3.1 Developer''},
|
---|
4606 | year = 1993
|
---|
4607 | }
|
---|
4608 |
|
---|
4609 | @book{Galletly96,
|
---|
4610 | keywords = {occam},
|
---|
4611 | author = {John Galletly},
|
---|
4612 | title = {{OCCAM} 2: Including {OCCAM} 2.1},
|
---|
4613 | publisher = {{UCL} (University College London) Press},
|
---|
4614 | address = {London},
|
---|
4615 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
4616 | year = 1996,
|
---|
4617 | }
|
---|
4618 |
|
---|
4619 | @techreport{Morrison88,
|
---|
4620 | keywords = {objects, concurrency, persistence},
|
---|
4621 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4622 | author = {R. Morrison and A. L. Brown and R. Carrick and R. Connor and A. Dearle},
|
---|
4623 | title = {On the integration of Object-Oriented and Process-Oriented computation in persistent environments},
|
---|
4624 | institution = {Department of Computational Science, University of St. Andrews, Scotland},
|
---|
4625 | number = {PPRR 57},
|
---|
4626 | month = jan,
|
---|
4627 | year = 1988,
|
---|
4628 | }
|
---|
4629 |
|
---|
4630 | @article{Peterson73,
|
---|
4631 | keywords = {goto, structured programming},
|
---|
4632 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4633 | author = {W. W. Peterson and T. Kasami and N. Tokura},
|
---|
4634 | title = {On the Capabilities of While, Repeat, and Exit Statements},
|
---|
4635 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
4636 | month = aug,
|
---|
4637 | year = 1973,
|
---|
4638 | volume = 16,
|
---|
4639 | number = 8,
|
---|
4640 | pages = {503-512}
|
---|
4641 | }
|
---|
4642 |
|
---|
4643 | @article{Baker82,
|
---|
4644 | keywords = {compilation},
|
---|
4645 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4646 | author = {Theodore P. Baker},
|
---|
4647 | title = {A One-Pass Algorithm for Overload Resolution in {Ada}},
|
---|
4648 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
4649 | year = 1982,
|
---|
4650 | month = oct,
|
---|
4651 | volume = 4,
|
---|
4652 | number = 4,
|
---|
4653 | pages = {601-614},
|
---|
4654 | abstract = {
|
---|
4655 | A simple method is presented for detecting ambiguities and finding
|
---|
4656 | the correct interpretations of expressions in the programming
|
---|
4657 | language Ada. Unlike previously reported solutions to this
|
---|
4658 | problem, which require multiple passes over a tree structure, the
|
---|
4659 | method described here operates in one bottom-up pass, during which
|
---|
4660 | a directed acyclic graph is produced. The correctness of this
|
---|
4661 | approach is demonstrated by a brief formal argument.
|
---|
4662 | },
|
---|
4663 | comment = {
|
---|
4664 | See also \cite{D:overload}.
|
---|
4665 | }
|
---|
4666 | }
|
---|
4667 |
|
---|
4668 | @techreport{OpenMP,
|
---|
4669 | keywords = {concurrency, openmp, spmd},
|
---|
4670 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4671 | author = {OpenMP Architecture Review Board},
|
---|
4672 | title = {OpenMP Application Program Interface, Version 4.0},
|
---|
4673 | month = jul,
|
---|
4674 | year = 2013,
|
---|
4675 | note = {\href{http://www.openmp.org/mp-documents/OpenMP4.0.0.pdf}{\textsf{http://\-www.openmp.org/\-mp-documents/\-OpenMP4.0.0.pdf}}},
|
---|
4676 | }
|
---|
4677 |
|
---|
4678 | @book{Deitel04,
|
---|
4679 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems},
|
---|
4680 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4681 | author = {Harvey M. Deitel and Paul J. Deitel and David R. Choffnes},
|
---|
4682 | title = {Operating Systems},
|
---|
4683 | publisher = {Pearson Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
4684 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
4685 | year = 2004,
|
---|
4686 | edition = {3rd},
|
---|
4687 | }
|
---|
4688 |
|
---|
4689 | @book{Stalling98,
|
---|
4690 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems},
|
---|
4691 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4692 | author = {William Stallings},
|
---|
4693 | title = {Operating Systems: Internals and Design Principles},
|
---|
4694 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
4695 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
4696 | year = 1998,
|
---|
4697 | edition = {3rd},
|
---|
4698 | }
|
---|
4699 |
|
---|
4700 | @book{Stalling01,
|
---|
4701 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems},
|
---|
4702 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4703 | author = {William Stallings},
|
---|
4704 | title = {Operating Systems: Internals and Design Principles},
|
---|
4705 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
4706 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
4707 | year = 2001,
|
---|
4708 | edition = {4th},
|
---|
4709 | }
|
---|
4710 |
|
---|
4711 | @book{Silberschatz91,
|
---|
4712 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems},
|
---|
4713 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4714 | author = {Abraham Silberschatz and James L. Peterson and Peter Galvin},
|
---|
4715 | title = {Operating System Concepts},
|
---|
4716 | publisher = {Addision-Wesley},
|
---|
4717 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
4718 | year = 1991,
|
---|
4719 | edition = {3rd},
|
---|
4720 | }
|
---|
4721 |
|
---|
4722 | @book{Tanenbaum87,
|
---|
4723 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems},
|
---|
4724 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4725 | author = {Andrew S. Tanenbaum},
|
---|
4726 | title = {Operating Systems : Design and Implementation},
|
---|
4727 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
4728 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
4729 | series = {Software Series},
|
---|
4730 | year = 1987,
|
---|
4731 | }
|
---|
4732 |
|
---|
4733 | @book{Hansen73,
|
---|
4734 | keywords = {monitors},
|
---|
4735 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4736 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}},
|
---|
4737 | title = {Operating System Principles},
|
---|
4738 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
4739 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
4740 | year = 1973,
|
---|
4741 | }
|
---|
4742 |
|
---|
4743 | @book{Bic03,
|
---|
4744 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems},
|
---|
4745 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4746 | author = {Lubomir F. Bic and Alan C. Shaw},
|
---|
4747 | title = {Operating System Principles},
|
---|
4748 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
4749 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
4750 | year = 2003,
|
---|
4751 | }
|
---|
4752 |
|
---|
4753 | @techreport{milner88,
|
---|
4754 | keywords = {},
|
---|
4755 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4756 | author = {Robin Milner},
|
---|
4757 | title = {Operational and Algebraic Semantics of Concurrent Processes},
|
---|
4758 | institution = {Laboratory for Foundations of Computer Science},
|
---|
4759 | year = 1988,
|
---|
4760 | address = {Department of Computer Science, University of Edinburgh, Edinburgh EH9 3JZ},
|
---|
4761 | month = feb,
|
---|
4762 | number = {ECS-LFCS-88-46}
|
---|
4763 | }
|
---|
4764 |
|
---|
4765 | @article{Ganzinger80,
|
---|
4766 | contributer = {a3moss@uwaterloo.ca},
|
---|
4767 | author = {Ganzinger, Harald and Ripken, Knut},
|
---|
4768 | title = {Operator Identification in {ADA}: Formal Specification, Complexity, and Concrete Implementation},
|
---|
4769 | journal = {SIGPLAN Notices},
|
---|
4770 | issue_date = {February 1980},
|
---|
4771 | volume = {15},
|
---|
4772 | number = {2},
|
---|
4773 | month = feb,
|
---|
4774 | year = {1980},
|
---|
4775 | issn = {0362-1340},
|
---|
4776 | pages = {30--42},
|
---|
4777 | numpages = {13},
|
---|
4778 | url = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/947586.947589},
|
---|
4779 | doi = {10.1145/947586.947589},
|
---|
4780 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
4781 | address = {New York, NY, USA}
|
---|
4782 | }
|
---|
4783 |
|
---|
4784 | @article{Ford82,
|
---|
4785 | keywords = {},
|
---|
4786 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4787 | author = {G. Ford and B. Hansche},
|
---|
4788 | title = {Optional, Repeatable, and Varying Type Parameters},
|
---|
4789 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
4790 | volume = 17,
|
---|
4791 | number = 2,
|
---|
4792 | month = feb,
|
---|
4793 | year = 1982,
|
---|
4794 | pages = {41-48},
|
---|
4795 | }
|
---|
4796 |
|
---|
4797 | @manual{pli,
|
---|
4798 | keywords = {PL/I},
|
---|
4799 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4800 | key = {IBM},
|
---|
4801 | title = {{OS} and {DOS} {PL/I} Reference Manual},
|
---|
4802 | organization= {International Business Machines},
|
---|
4803 | edition = {1st},
|
---|
4804 | month = sep,
|
---|
4805 | year = 1981,
|
---|
4806 | note = {Manual GC26-3977-0},
|
---|
4807 | }
|
---|
4808 |
|
---|
4809 | @techreport{D:overload,
|
---|
4810 | keywords = {overload resolution, compilation},
|
---|
4811 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4812 | author = {M. Dausmann et. al.},
|
---|
4813 | title = {Overloading in {Ada}},
|
---|
4814 | institution = {Universitat Karlsruhe},
|
---|
4815 | year = 1979,
|
---|
4816 | number = {23/79},
|
---|
4817 | comment = {
|
---|
4818 | Probably the earliest description of the two-pass (bottom-up,
|
---|
4819 | top-down) overload resolution algorithm. See also
|
---|
4820 | \cite{PW:overload,WS:overload,PDM:overload,Cor:overload,Bak:overload}.
|
---|
4821 | }
|
---|
4822 | }
|
---|
4823 |
|
---|
4824 | @article{EB87,
|
---|
4825 | keywords = {packages, private types, assignment, equality},
|
---|
4826 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4827 | author = {J. Dana Eckart and Richard J. LeBlanc},
|
---|
4828 | title = {Overloading in the {Ada} Language: Is it too restrictive?},
|
---|
4829 | journal = {Computer Languages},
|
---|
4830 | year = 1987,
|
---|
4831 | volume = 12, number = {3/4}, pages = {163-172},
|
---|
4832 | abstract = {
|
---|
4833 | Packages in the Ada language provide a mechanism for extending the
|
---|
4834 | language through the development of additional data types. Such
|
---|
4835 | types can be better integrated into the language using operator
|
---|
4836 | overloading; however, key limitations prevent new types from being
|
---|
4837 | transparently integrated into the language. Allowing function
|
---|
4838 | names to overload private type names would give a cleaner and
|
---|
4839 | clearer mechanism for building values of these types. Furthermore,
|
---|
4840 | by allowing redefinitions of ``:='' and by making it easier to
|
---|
4841 | overload ``='' for private types, Ada coud be transformed into a
|
---|
4842 | more expressive language.
|
---|
4843 | }
|
---|
4844 | }
|
---|
4845 |
|
---|
4846 | @article{PW:overload,
|
---|
4847 | keywords = {compilation},
|
---|
4848 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4849 | author = {Guido Persch and Georg Winterstein and Manfred Dausman and Sophia Drossopoulou},
|
---|
4850 | title = {Overloading in Preliminary {Ada}},
|
---|
4851 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
4852 | year = 1980,
|
---|
4853 | month = nov, volume = 15, number = 11, pages = {47-56},
|
---|
4854 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM-SIGPLAN Symposium on the {Ada} Programming
|
---|
4855 | Language},
|
---|
4856 | comment = {
|
---|
4857 | The two-pass (bottom-up, then top-down) algorithm, with a proof
|
---|
4858 | that two passes suffice. See also \cite{D:overload}.
|
---|
4859 | }
|
---|
4860 | }
|
---|
4861 |
|
---|
4862 | @article{SR,
|
---|
4863 | keywords = {concurrency, messages, rendezvous},
|
---|
4864 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4865 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews and Ronald A. Olsson and Michael Coffin and
|
---|
4866 | Irving Elshoff and Kelvin Nilsen and Titus Purdin and Gregg Townsend},
|
---|
4867 | title = {An Overview of the {SR} Language and Implementation},
|
---|
4868 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
4869 | month = jan,
|
---|
4870 | year = 1988,
|
---|
4871 | volume = 10,
|
---|
4872 | number = 1,
|
---|
4873 | pages = {51-86},
|
---|
4874 | }
|
---|
4875 |
|
---|
4876 | % P
|
---|
4877 |
|
---|
4878 | @article{Andrews91,
|
---|
4879 | keywords = {general concurrency},
|
---|
4880 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4881 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews},
|
---|
4882 | title = {Paradigms for Process Interaction in Distributed Programs},
|
---|
4883 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
4884 | volume = 23,
|
---|
4885 | number = 1,
|
---|
4886 | month = mar,
|
---|
4887 | year = 1991,
|
---|
4888 | pages = {49-90},
|
---|
4889 | }
|
---|
4890 |
|
---|
4891 | @book{PPC++,
|
---|
4892 | keywords = {concurrency, parallel, distributed, C++},
|
---|
4893 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4894 | editor = {Gregory V. Wilson and Paul Lu},
|
---|
4895 | title = {Parallel Programming in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
4896 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
4897 | series = {Scientific and Engineering Computation Series},
|
---|
4898 | year = 1996,
|
---|
4899 | pages = {1-42},
|
---|
4900 | }
|
---|
4901 |
|
---|
4902 | @incollection{Stroustrup96,
|
---|
4903 | keywords = {concurrency, C++},
|
---|
4904 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4905 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
4906 | title = {A Perspective on Concurrency in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
4907 | editor = {Gregory V. Wilson and Paul Lu},
|
---|
4908 | booktitle = {Parallel Programming in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
4909 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
4910 | series = {Scientific and Engineering Computation Series},
|
---|
4911 | year = 1996,
|
---|
4912 | pages = {xxvi-xxvii},
|
---|
4913 | }
|
---|
4914 |
|
---|
4915 | @incollection{Yang96b,
|
---|
4916 | keywords = {concurrency, C++},
|
---|
4917 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4918 | author = {Shelby X. Yang and Dennis Gannon and Peter Beckman and Jacob Gotwals and Neelakantan Sundaresan},
|
---|
4919 | editor = {Gregory V. Wilson and Paul Lu},
|
---|
4920 | title = {p{C}++},
|
---|
4921 | booktitle = {Parallel Programming in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
4922 | publisher = {MIT Press},
|
---|
4923 | address = {Cambridge},
|
---|
4924 | series = {Scientific and Engineering Computation Series},
|
---|
4925 | pages = {507-546},
|
---|
4926 | year = 1996,
|
---|
4927 | }
|
---|
4928 |
|
---|
4929 | @article{goguen84,
|
---|
4930 | keywords = {},
|
---|
4931 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4932 | author = {Goseph A. Goguen},
|
---|
4933 | title = {Parameterized Programming},
|
---|
4934 | journal = ieeese,
|
---|
4935 | year = 1984,
|
---|
4936 | month = sep, volume = "SE-10", number = 5, pages = {528-543},
|
---|
4937 | abstract = {
|
---|
4938 | Parameterized programming is a powerful technique for the reliable
|
---|
4939 | reuse of software. In this technique, modules are parameterized
|
---|
4940 | over very general interfaces that describe what properties of an
|
---|
4941 | environment are required for the module to work correctly.
|
---|
4942 | Reusability is enhanced by the flexibility of the parameterization
|
---|
4943 | mechanism proposed here. Reliability is further enhanced by
|
---|
4944 | permitting interface requirements to include more than purely
|
---|
4945 | syntactic information. This paper introduces three new ideas that
|
---|
4946 | seem especially useful in supporting parameterized programming: 1)
|
---|
4947 | {\em theories}, which declare global properties of program modules
|
---|
4948 | and interfaces; 2) {\em views}, which connect theories with program
|
---|
4949 | modules in an elegant way; and 3) {\em module expressions}, a kind
|
---|
4950 | of general structured program transformation which produces new
|
---|
4951 | modules by modifying and combining existing modules. Although
|
---|
4952 | these ideas are illustrated with some simple examples in the OBJ
|
---|
4953 | programming language, they should also be taken as proposals for an
|
---|
4954 | Ada library system, for adding modules to Prolog, and as
|
---|
4955 | considerations for future language design efforts. OBJ is an
|
---|
4956 | ultra-high level programming language, based upon rewrite rules,
|
---|
4957 | that incorporates these ideas, and many others from modern
|
---|
4958 | programming methodology.
|
---|
4959 | }
|
---|
4960 | }
|
---|
4961 |
|
---|
4962 | @inproceedings{c++:templates,
|
---|
4963 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
4964 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4965 | title = {Parameterized Types for {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
4966 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference},
|
---|
4967 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
4968 | year = 1988, pages = {1-18}
|
---|
4969 | }
|
---|
4970 |
|
---|
4971 | @inproceedings{Boehm85,
|
---|
4972 | keywords = {second-order unification},
|
---|
4973 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
4974 | author = {Hans-J. Boehm},
|
---|
4975 | title = {Partial Polymorphic Type Inference is Undecidable},
|
---|
4976 | booktitle = {26th Annual Symposium on Foundations of Computer Science},
|
---|
4977 | year = 1985,
|
---|
4978 | pages = {339-345},
|
---|
4979 | organization= {IEEE Computer Society},
|
---|
4980 | publisher = {IEEE Computer Society Press},
|
---|
4981 | address = {1730 Massachusetts Avenue, N.W, Washington, D.C. 20036-1903},
|
---|
4982 | summary = {
|
---|
4983 | Given a base typed lambda calculus with function types, type
|
---|
4984 | abstractions, and a recursive expression \(\mbox{fix } x:t.e\),
|
---|
4985 | then type inference for the partially typed language
|
---|
4986 | \begin{eqnarray}
|
---|
4987 | \lambda x:\tau.e &\Rightarrow& \lambda x.e \\
|
---|
4988 | \mbox{fix } x:\tau.e &\Rightarrow& \mbox{fix } x.e \\
|
---|
4989 | e \tau &\Rightarrow& e ?
|
---|
4990 | \end{eqnarray}
|
---|
4991 | is undecidable.
|
---|
4992 | }
|
---|
4993 | }
|
---|
4994 |
|
---|
4995 | @book{Pascal,
|
---|
4996 | keywords = {Pascal},
|
---|
4997 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
4998 | author = {Kathleen Jensen and Niklaus Wirth},
|
---|
4999 | title = {{P}ascal User Manual and Report},
|
---|
5000 | publisher = {Springer--Verlag},
|
---|
5001 | year = 1985,
|
---|
5002 | edition = {3rd},
|
---|
5003 | note = {Revised by Andrew B. Mickel and James F. Miner, ISO Pascal Standard}
|
---|
5004 | }
|
---|
5005 |
|
---|
5006 | @book{Pascal:old,
|
---|
5007 | keywords = {Pascal},
|
---|
5008 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5009 | author = {Kathleen Jensen and Niklaus Wirth},
|
---|
5010 | title = {{P}ascal User Manual and Report},
|
---|
5011 | publisher = {Springer--Verlag},
|
---|
5012 | year = 1975,
|
---|
5013 | edition = {1st},
|
---|
5014 | }
|
---|
5015 |
|
---|
5016 | @article{Turba85,
|
---|
5017 | keywords = {Pascal, exception handling, inheritance},
|
---|
5018 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5019 | author = {Thomas N. Turba},
|
---|
5020 | title = {The {P}ascal Exception Handling Proposal},
|
---|
5021 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5022 | volume = 20,
|
---|
5023 | number = 8,
|
---|
5024 | month = aug,
|
---|
5025 | year = 1985,
|
---|
5026 | pages = {93-98},
|
---|
5027 | }
|
---|
5028 |
|
---|
5029 | @manual{Pascal/VS,
|
---|
5030 | keywords = {PL/I},
|
---|
5031 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5032 | key = {IBM},
|
---|
5033 | title = {{P}ascal/{VS} Language Reference Manual},
|
---|
5034 | organization= {International Business Machines},
|
---|
5035 | edition = {1st},
|
---|
5036 | year = 1981,
|
---|
5037 | note = {Manual SH20-6168-1},
|
---|
5038 | }
|
---|
5039 |
|
---|
5040 | @article{Anderson90,
|
---|
5041 | keywords = {spin locks, back off, performance},
|
---|
5042 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5043 | author = {Thomas E. Anderson},
|
---|
5044 | title = {The Performance of Spin Lock Alternatives for Shared-Memory Multiprocessors},
|
---|
5045 | journal = ieeepds,
|
---|
5046 | month = jan,
|
---|
5047 | year = 1990,
|
---|
5048 | volume = 1,
|
---|
5049 | number = 1,
|
---|
5050 | pages = {6-16},
|
---|
5051 | }
|
---|
5052 |
|
---|
5053 | @article{poly,
|
---|
5054 | keywords = {Poly, Standard ML, Russell, persistence},
|
---|
5055 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5056 | author = {David C. J. Matthews},
|
---|
5057 | title = {Poly Manual},
|
---|
5058 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5059 | month = sep, year = 1985,
|
---|
5060 | volume = 20, number = 9, pages = {52-76}
|
---|
5061 | }
|
---|
5062 |
|
---|
5063 | @techreport{Atkinson87b,
|
---|
5064 | keywords = {naming, persistence},
|
---|
5065 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5066 | author = {M. P. Atkinson and R. Morrison},
|
---|
5067 | title = {Polymorphic Names and Iterations},
|
---|
5068 | institution = {Universities of Glasgow and St. Andrews, Scotland},
|
---|
5069 | number = {PPRR-53-87},
|
---|
5070 | month = nov,
|
---|
5071 | year = 1987,
|
---|
5072 | }
|
---|
5073 |
|
---|
5074 | @book{Harland,
|
---|
5075 | keywords = {},
|
---|
5076 | author = {David M. Harland},
|
---|
5077 | title = {Polymorphic Programming Languages: Design and Implementation},
|
---|
5078 | publisher = {Ellis Horwood},
|
---|
5079 | year = 1984,
|
---|
5080 | series = {Computers and their Applications},
|
---|
5081 | address = {Market Cross House, Cooper Street, Chichester, West Sussex,
|
---|
5082 | PO19 1EB, England},
|
---|
5083 | summary = {
|
---|
5084 | The principles of Procedural Abstraction, Data Type Completeness,
|
---|
5085 | Declaration Correspondence, and Orthogonality are ruthlessly applied
|
---|
5086 | to the design of a polymorphic language.
|
---|
5087 | }
|
---|
5088 | }
|
---|
5089 |
|
---|
5090 | @unpublished{poa,
|
---|
5091 | keywords = {Force N, type inference, reusability, transcendance},
|
---|
5092 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5093 | author = {G. V. Cormack and A. K. Wright},
|
---|
5094 | title = {Polymorphism, Overloading, and Abstraction},
|
---|
5095 | note = {personal communication}
|
---|
5096 | }
|
---|
5097 |
|
---|
5098 | @inproceedings{forceone:impl,
|
---|
5099 | keywords = {Parametric polymorphism, ForceOne},
|
---|
5100 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5101 | author = {G. V. Cormack and A. K. Wright},
|
---|
5102 | title = {Polymorphism in the Compiled Language {ForceOne}},
|
---|
5103 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 20th Hawaii International Conference on Systems Sciences},
|
---|
5104 | month = jan,
|
---|
5105 | year = 1987,
|
---|
5106 | pages = {284-292},
|
---|
5107 | }
|
---|
5108 |
|
---|
5109 | @incollection{POOL-T,
|
---|
5110 | keywords = {objects, concurrency},
|
---|
5111 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5112 | author = {Pierre America},
|
---|
5113 | title = {POOL-T: A Parallel Object-Oriented Language},
|
---|
5114 | booktitle = {Object-Oriented Concurrent Programming},
|
---|
5115 | publisher = {The MIT Press},
|
---|
5116 | year = 1987,
|
---|
5117 | pages = {199-220},
|
---|
5118 | editor = {Akinori Yonezawa and Mario Tokoro}
|
---|
5119 | }
|
---|
5120 |
|
---|
5121 | @article{Hardgrave76,
|
---|
5122 | keywords = {positional, keyword, parameters, arguments},
|
---|
5123 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5124 | author = {W. T. Hardgrave},
|
---|
5125 | title = {Positional versus Keyword Parameter Communication in Programming Languages},
|
---|
5126 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5127 | volume = 11,
|
---|
5128 | number = 5,
|
---|
5129 | month = may,
|
---|
5130 | year = 1976,
|
---|
5131 | pages = {52-58},
|
---|
5132 | }
|
---|
5133 |
|
---|
5134 | @book{PowerPC,
|
---|
5135 | key = {PowerPC processor},
|
---|
5136 | title = {Programming Environments Manual for 32-Bit Implementations of the PowerPC ArchitectureARM Architecture},
|
---|
5137 | publisher = {Freescale Semiconductor},
|
---|
5138 | volume = {MPCFPE32B},
|
---|
5139 | edition = {Rev. 3},
|
---|
5140 | month = 9,
|
---|
5141 | year = 2005,
|
---|
5142 | }
|
---|
5143 |
|
---|
5144 | @article{Ada:preliminary,
|
---|
5145 | keywords = {Ada},
|
---|
5146 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5147 | author = {Jean D. Ichbiah and Bernd Krieg-Brueckner and Brian A. Wichmann
|
---|
5148 | and Henry F. Ledgard and Jean-Claude Heliard and Jean-Raymond Abrial
|
---|
5149 | and John G. P. Barnes and Olivier Roubine},
|
---|
5150 | title = {Preliminary {Ada} Reference Manual},
|
---|
5151 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5152 | volume = 14,
|
---|
5153 | number = 6,
|
---|
5154 | month = jun,
|
---|
5155 | year = 1979,
|
---|
5156 | note = {Part A},
|
---|
5157 | }
|
---|
5158 |
|
---|
5159 | @techreport{Forsythe,
|
---|
5160 | author = {John C. Reynolds},
|
---|
5161 | title = {Preliminary Design of the Programming Language {Forsythe}},
|
---|
5162 | institution = {Carnegie Mellon University},
|
---|
5163 | number = {CMU-CS-88-159},
|
---|
5164 | month = jun,
|
---|
5165 | year = 1988,
|
---|
5166 | }
|
---|
5167 |
|
---|
5168 | @article{PRESTO,
|
---|
5169 | keywords = {concurrency, threads},
|
---|
5170 | contributer = {dgharriss@plg},
|
---|
5171 | author = {B. N. Bershad and E. D. Lazowska and H. M. Levy},
|
---|
5172 | title = {{PRESTO}: A System for Object-oriented Parallel Programming},
|
---|
5173 | journal = spe,
|
---|
5174 | volume = 18,
|
---|
5175 | number = 8,
|
---|
5176 | month = aug,
|
---|
5177 | year = 1988,
|
---|
5178 | pages = {713-732}
|
---|
5179 | }
|
---|
5180 |
|
---|
5181 | @book{Ben-Ari82,
|
---|
5182 | keywords = {concurrency, parallel, programming languages},
|
---|
5183 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5184 | author = {Mordechai Ben-Ari},
|
---|
5185 | title = {Principles of Concurrent Programming},
|
---|
5186 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall International},
|
---|
5187 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
5188 | year = 1982,
|
---|
5189 | }
|
---|
5190 |
|
---|
5191 | @book{Tennent81,
|
---|
5192 | author = {R. D. Tennent},
|
---|
5193 | title = {Principles of Programming Languages},
|
---|
5194 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall International},
|
---|
5195 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
5196 | year = 1981,
|
---|
5197 | series = {Series in Computer Science}
|
---|
5198 | }
|
---|
5199 |
|
---|
5200 | @article{Lister77,
|
---|
5201 | keywords = {monitors, nested monitor calls},
|
---|
5202 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5203 | author = {Andrew Lister},
|
---|
5204 | title = {The Problem of Nested Monitor Calls},
|
---|
5205 | journal = osr,
|
---|
5206 | volume = 11,
|
---|
5207 | number = 3,
|
---|
5208 | month = jul,
|
---|
5209 | year = 1977,
|
---|
5210 | pages = {5-7},
|
---|
5211 | }
|
---|
5212 |
|
---|
5213 | @article{psa:persistence,
|
---|
5214 | keywords = {persistence, first-class procedures, closure, PS-Algol,
|
---|
5215 | Abstract Data Types},
|
---|
5216 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5217 | author = {Malcolm P. Atkinson and Ronald Morrison},
|
---|
5218 | title = {Procedures as Persistent Data Objects},
|
---|
5219 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
5220 | volume = {7}, number = {4},
|
---|
5221 | pages = {539-559},
|
---|
5222 | month = oct, year = 1985,
|
---|
5223 | comment = {
|
---|
5224 | PS-Algol has ``structures'', accessible only through ``pntrs''.
|
---|
5225 | Pntrs can refer to any type of structure. Field references involve
|
---|
5226 | a run-time check. This, plus first-class procedures, can simulate
|
---|
5227 | abstract data types. Procedure variables operating on pntrs
|
---|
5228 | simulate ADT operations. A block defines a structure to implement
|
---|
5229 | the ADT, and assigns procedures to the variables. Functions
|
---|
5230 | returning structures containing procedures simulate multiple
|
---|
5231 | implementations and parameterized ADTs.
|
---|
5232 |
|
---|
5233 | An outer procedure that returns a procedure that contains
|
---|
5234 | (non-local) references to the outer procedure's parameters
|
---|
5235 | implements partial evaluation.
|
---|
5236 |
|
---|
5237 | Modules can be simulated like ADT's. The module itself is a
|
---|
5238 | structure instance that is placed in persistent storage, and the
|
---|
5239 | module is imported by fetching it from the persistent store.
|
---|
5240 | Multiple instances of modules are easy. Installation of new
|
---|
5241 | versions can be done by replacing the version in the database.
|
---|
5242 | }
|
---|
5243 | }
|
---|
5244 |
|
---|
5245 | @article{Procol89,
|
---|
5246 | keywords = {active objects, object-oriented languages,
|
---|
5247 | object-based languages, explicit per-object protocol},
|
---|
5248 | contributer = {akgoel@plg},
|
---|
5249 | author = {Jan van den Bos and Chris Laffra},
|
---|
5250 | title = {PROCOL: A Parallel Object Language with Protocols},
|
---|
5251 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5252 | volume = 24,
|
---|
5253 | number = 10,
|
---|
5254 | month = oct,
|
---|
5255 | year = 1989,
|
---|
5256 | pages = {95-102},
|
---|
5257 | note = {Proceedings of the OOPSLA'89 Conference, Oct. 1--6, 1989, New Orleans, Lousiana},
|
---|
5258 | abstract = {},
|
---|
5259 | }
|
---|
5260 |
|
---|
5261 | @book{Butenhof97,
|
---|
5262 | keywords = {PThreads, concurrency},
|
---|
5263 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5264 | author = {David R. Butenhof},
|
---|
5265 | title = {Programming with {POSIX} Threads},
|
---|
5266 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
5267 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
5268 | series = {Professional Computing},
|
---|
5269 | year = 1997,
|
---|
5270 | }
|
---|
5271 |
|
---|
5272 | @book{SETL,
|
---|
5273 | keywords = {SETL},
|
---|
5274 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5275 | author = {J. T. Schwartz and R. B. K. Dewar and E. Dubinsky and E. Schonberg},
|
---|
5276 | title = {Programming with Sets: An Introduction to {SETL}},
|
---|
5277 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
5278 | year = 1986,
|
---|
5279 | }
|
---|
5280 |
|
---|
5281 | @book{Genuys68,
|
---|
5282 | keywords = {contains Dijkstra's Cooperating Sequential Processes},
|
---|
5283 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5284 | editor = {F. Genuys},
|
---|
5285 | title = {Programming Languages},
|
---|
5286 | publisher = {Academic Press},
|
---|
5287 | address = {London, New York},
|
---|
5288 | year = 1968,
|
---|
5289 | note = {NATO Advanced Study Institute, Villard-de-Lans, 1966}
|
---|
5290 | }
|
---|
5291 |
|
---|
5292 | @manual{ANSI99:C,
|
---|
5293 | keywords = {ANSI C 99},
|
---|
5294 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5295 | title = {Programming Languages -- {C}},
|
---|
5296 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 9899:1999 (E)},
|
---|
5297 | publisher = {American National Standards Institute},
|
---|
5298 | address = {www.ansi.org},
|
---|
5299 | year = 1999,
|
---|
5300 | }
|
---|
5301 |
|
---|
5302 | @manual{ANSI98:C++,
|
---|
5303 | keywords = {ANSI C++ 98},
|
---|
5304 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5305 | key = {C++98},
|
---|
5306 | title = {Programming Languages -- {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
5307 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 14882:1998 (E)},
|
---|
5308 | publisher = {American National Standards Institute},
|
---|
5309 | address = {www.ansi.org},
|
---|
5310 | year = 1998,
|
---|
5311 | }
|
---|
5312 |
|
---|
5313 | @manual{ANSI14:C++,
|
---|
5314 | keywords = {ISO/IEC C++ 14},
|
---|
5315 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5316 | key = {C++14},
|
---|
5317 | title = {Programming Languages -- {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
5318 | edition = {4th},
|
---|
5319 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 14882:2014 (E)},
|
---|
5320 | publisher = {International Standard Organization},
|
---|
5321 | address = {http://www.iso.org},
|
---|
5322 | year = 2014,
|
---|
5323 | }
|
---|
5324 |
|
---|
5325 | @manual{MS:VisualC++,
|
---|
5326 | keywords = {Microsoft Visual C++},
|
---|
5327 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5328 | title = {Microsoft Visual {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} .NET Language Reference},
|
---|
5329 | organization= {Microsoft Corporation},
|
---|
5330 | year = 2002,
|
---|
5331 | note = {Microsoft Press, Redmond, Washington, U.S.A.},
|
---|
5332 | }
|
---|
5333 |
|
---|
5334 | @article{HasselBring00,
|
---|
5335 | keywords = {concurrency, prototyping},
|
---|
5336 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5337 | author = {Wilhelm Hasselbring},
|
---|
5338 | title = {Programming Languages and Systems for Prototyping Concurrent Applications},
|
---|
5339 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
5340 | volume = 32,
|
---|
5341 | number = 1,
|
---|
5342 | month = mar,
|
---|
5343 | year = 2000,
|
---|
5344 | pages = {43-79},
|
---|
5345 | }
|
---|
5346 |
|
---|
5347 | @article{LLgen,
|
---|
5348 | keywords = {ll(1), parser generator, separate compilation},
|
---|
5349 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5350 | author = {Dick Grune and Ceriel J. J. Jacobs},
|
---|
5351 | title = {A Programmer-friendly LL(1) Parser Generator},
|
---|
5352 | journal = spe,
|
---|
5353 | month = jan, year = 1988,
|
---|
5354 | volume = 18, number = 1, pages = {29-33},
|
---|
5355 | comment = {
|
---|
5356 | LLgen generates C-language recursive-descent parsers. The input
|
---|
5357 | contains procedure-like rules with alternation and repetition
|
---|
5358 | constructs on the right, and (typed) parameters on the left.
|
---|
5359 | C actions are specified between items in the right side.
|
---|
5360 | Alternation and repetition (reduce and shift) conflicts can be
|
---|
5361 | resolved statically or at run time.
|
---|
5362 |
|
---|
5363 | A grammar can be specified in several files. All files must be
|
---|
5364 | submitted to LLgen at once, but if the C file generated is no
|
---|
5365 | different from the old version, then the old version is not
|
---|
5366 | replaced and hence need not be recompiled, which saves lots of
|
---|
5367 | time.
|
---|
5368 |
|
---|
5369 | When an incorrect token is found, the automatic error recovery
|
---|
5370 | algorithm discards tokens until an ``acceptable'' token is found;
|
---|
5371 | if the acceptable token is not correct, a correct one is inserted.
|
---|
5372 | }
|
---|
5373 | }
|
---|
5374 |
|
---|
5375 | @techreport{russell,
|
---|
5376 | keywords = {Russell},
|
---|
5377 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5378 | author = {H. Boehm and A. Demers and J. Donahue},
|
---|
5379 | title = {A Programmer's Introduction to Russell},
|
---|
5380 | institution = {Rice University},
|
---|
5381 | year = 1985,
|
---|
5382 | number = {85-16}
|
---|
5383 | }
|
---|
5384 |
|
---|
5385 | @techreport{PDM89,
|
---|
5386 | keywords = {existential types, universal types},
|
---|
5387 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5388 | author = {Benjamin Pierce and Scott Dietzen and Spiro Michaylov},
|
---|
5389 | title = {Programming in Higher-Order Typed Lambda Calculi},
|
---|
5390 | institution = {School of Computer Science, Carnegie Mellon University},
|
---|
5391 | year = 1989,
|
---|
5392 | address = {Pittsburg, PA 15213-3890},
|
---|
5393 | month = mar, number = {CMU-CS-89-111},
|
---|
5394 | abstract = {
|
---|
5395 | This tutorial presents a hierarchy of increasingly powerful
|
---|
5396 | languages, beginning with Church's simply typed
|
---|
5397 | \(\lambda\)-calculus (\(F_1\)) and the second-order polymorphic
|
---|
5398 | \(\lambda\)-calculus of Girard and Reynolds, and culminating in a
|
---|
5399 | fragment of Girard's \(\omega\)-order polymorphic
|
---|
5400 | \(\lambda\)-calculus (\(F_\omega\)). Our focus throughout is on
|
---|
5401 | the unusual style of programming that arises in these languages,
|
---|
5402 | where all functions are total and the primary control construct is
|
---|
5403 | iteration rather than general recursion.
|
---|
5404 | }
|
---|
5405 | }
|
---|
5406 |
|
---|
5407 | @book{Modula-2,
|
---|
5408 | keywords = {modules, coroutines},
|
---|
5409 | contributer = {pabuhr},
|
---|
5410 | author = {Niklaus Wirth},
|
---|
5411 | title = {Programming in Modula-2},
|
---|
5412 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
5413 | address = {New York},
|
---|
5414 | year = 1988,
|
---|
5415 | edition = {4th},
|
---|
5416 | series = {Texts and Monographs in Computer Science},
|
---|
5417 | }
|
---|
5418 |
|
---|
5419 | @manual{Ada,
|
---|
5420 | keywords = {Ada, packages, tasks, exceptions},
|
---|
5421 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5422 | title = {The Programming Language {Ada}: Reference Manual},
|
---|
5423 | organization= {United States Department of Defense},
|
---|
5424 | edition = {{ANSI/MIL-STD-1815A-1983}},
|
---|
5425 | month = feb,
|
---|
5426 | year = 1983,
|
---|
5427 | note = {Springer, New York},
|
---|
5428 | }
|
---|
5429 |
|
---|
5430 | @manual{ada:old,
|
---|
5431 | keywords = {Ada, packages, tasks, exceptions},
|
---|
5432 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5433 | title = {The Programming Language {Ada}: Reference Manual},
|
---|
5434 | organization= {United States Department of Defense},
|
---|
5435 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
5436 | year = 1981
|
---|
5437 | }
|
---|
5438 |
|
---|
5439 | @book{Ghezzi,
|
---|
5440 | keywords = {},
|
---|
5441 | author = {Carlo Ghezzi and Mehdi Jazayeri},
|
---|
5442 | title = {Programming Language Concepts},
|
---|
5443 | publisher = {Wiley},
|
---|
5444 | year = 1982
|
---|
5445 | }
|
---|
5446 |
|
---|
5447 | @article{ConcurrentPascal,
|
---|
5448 | keywords = {Concurrent Pascal},
|
---|
5449 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5450 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}},
|
---|
5451 | title = {The Programming Language Concurrent Pascal},
|
---|
5452 | journal = ieeese,
|
---|
5453 | volume = 2,
|
---|
5454 | month = jun,
|
---|
5455 | year = 1975,
|
---|
5456 | pages = {199-206}
|
---|
5457 | }
|
---|
5458 |
|
---|
5459 | @phdthesis{Buhr85:thesis,
|
---|
5460 | keywords = {},
|
---|
5461 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5462 | author = {P. A. Buhr},
|
---|
5463 | title = {A Programming System},
|
---|
5464 | school = {University of Manitoba},
|
---|
5465 | year = {1985}
|
---|
5466 | }
|
---|
5467 |
|
---|
5468 | @techreport{pierce91,
|
---|
5469 | keywords = {typed lambda calculus},
|
---|
5470 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5471 | author = {Benjamin C. Pierce},
|
---|
5472 | title = {Programming with Intersection Types, Union Types, and Polymorphism},
|
---|
5473 | institution = {Carnegie Mellon University},
|
---|
5474 | year = 1991,
|
---|
5475 | month = feb, number = "CMU-CS-91-106",
|
---|
5476 | annote = {
|
---|
5477 | Discusses a typed lambda calculus with
|
---|
5478 | \begin{itemize}
|
---|
5479 | \item
|
---|
5480 | Intersection types \(\tau = \tau_1\wedge\tau_2\) with \(\tau \le
|
---|
5481 | \tau_i\) for all \(i\).
|
---|
5482 | \item
|
---|
5483 | Union types \(\tau = \tau_1\vee\tau_2\) with \(\tau_i \le \tau\),
|
---|
5484 | and with implicit coercions from \(tau_i\) to \(\tau\). Only
|
---|
5485 | operations valid for both element types can be applied to the
|
---|
5486 | union; there are no projections. Union types are to variant
|
---|
5487 | records as set union is to disjoint set union.
|
---|
5488 | \item
|
---|
5489 | Function types and universal quantification, with subtyping rules.
|
---|
5490 | When functions and arguments intersections, the result of
|
---|
5491 | application is the intersection of all valid combinations.
|
---|
5492 | \item
|
---|
5493 | Distribution rules for combinations of types.
|
---|
5494 | \item
|
---|
5495 | "Union elimination": "case \(x = e\) of \(e'\)", where \(e\) is a
|
---|
5496 | union, has type \(\tau\) if \(e'\) has that type with \(x\) having
|
---|
5497 | every element type of the union.
|
---|
5498 | \item
|
---|
5499 | "Finitary quantification": "for \(t\) in \(\tau_1,\ldots,\tau_n.e\)"
|
---|
5500 | typechecks \(e\) with \(t\) bound to each choice, and intersects
|
---|
5501 | the results.
|
---|
5502 | \end{itemize}
|
---|
5503 |
|
---|
5504 | Examples include: type of "natural" numbers, treated as a union of
|
---|
5505 | "zero" and "positive" types; default parameters, faked by using an
|
---|
5506 | argument that is an intersection of a data type and a function
|
---|
5507 | taking an explicit argument.
|
---|
5508 |
|
---|
5509 | Unions can be mostly faked, according to Mitchell:
|
---|
5510 | \[\tau_1\vee\tau_2 \equiv
|
---|
5511 | \forall\tau.(\tau_1\on\tau)\wedge(\tau_2\on\tau)\]
|
---|
5512 | }
|
---|
5513 | }
|
---|
5514 |
|
---|
5515 | @article{promises,
|
---|
5516 | keywords = {futures, Argus, call streams, rpc},
|
---|
5517 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5518 | author = {Barbara Liskov and Liuba Shrira},
|
---|
5519 | title = {Promises: Linguistic Support for Efficient Asynchronous
|
---|
5520 | Procedure Calls in Distributed Systems},
|
---|
5521 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5522 | year = 1988,
|
---|
5523 | month = jul, volume = 23, number = 7, pages = {260-267},
|
---|
5524 | note = {Proceedings of the SIGPLAN '88 Conference on Programming Language
|
---|
5525 | Design and Implementation},
|
---|
5526 | abstract = {
|
---|
5527 | This paper deals with the integration of an efficient asynchronous
|
---|
5528 | remote procedure call mechanism into a programming language. It
|
---|
5529 | describes a new data type called a {\em promise} that was designed
|
---|
5530 | to support asynchronous calls. Promises allow a caller to run in
|
---|
5531 | parallel with a call and to pick up the results of the call,
|
---|
5532 | including any exceptions it raises, in a convenient and type-safe
|
---|
5533 | manner. The paper also discusses efficient composition of
|
---|
5534 | sequences of asynchronous calls to different locations in a
|
---|
5535 | network.
|
---|
5536 | }
|
---|
5537 | }
|
---|
5538 |
|
---|
5539 | @article{Cook89,
|
---|
5540 | keywords = {},
|
---|
5541 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5542 | author = {W. R. Cook},
|
---|
5543 | title = {A Proposal for Making {Eiffel} Type-safe},
|
---|
5544 | journal = {The Computer Journal},
|
---|
5545 | year = 1989,
|
---|
5546 | volume = 32, number = 4, pages = {305-311},
|
---|
5547 | abstract = {
|
---|
5548 |
|
---|
5549 | }
|
---|
5550 | }
|
---|
5551 |
|
---|
5552 | @inproceedings{Foxall79,
|
---|
5553 | keywords = {},
|
---|
5554 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5555 | author = {D. G. Foxall and M. L. Joliat and R. F. Kamel and J. J. Miceli},
|
---|
5556 | title = {{PROTEL}: A High Level Language for Telephony},
|
---|
5557 | booktitle = {Proceedings 3rd International Computer Software and Applications Conference},
|
---|
5558 | month = nov,
|
---|
5559 | year = 1979,
|
---|
5560 | pages = {193-197},
|
---|
5561 | }
|
---|
5562 |
|
---|
5563 | @techreport{PS-Algol,
|
---|
5564 | keywords = {algol, persistence},
|
---|
5565 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5566 | key = {PS-Algol},
|
---|
5567 | title = {The {PS-Algol} Reference Manual, 4th Ed.},
|
---|
5568 | author = {},
|
---|
5569 | institution = {University of Glasgow and St. Andrews, Scotland},
|
---|
5570 | number = {PPRR 12},
|
---|
5571 | month = jun,
|
---|
5572 | year = 1987,
|
---|
5573 | }
|
---|
5574 |
|
---|
5575 | @manual{Python,
|
---|
5576 | keywords = {Python},
|
---|
5577 | contributer = {pabuhr},
|
---|
5578 | title = {Python Reference Manual, Release 2.5},
|
---|
5579 | author = {Guido van Rossum},
|
---|
5580 | organization= {Python Software Foundation},
|
---|
5581 | month = sep,
|
---|
5582 | year = 2006,
|
---|
5583 | note = {Fred L. Drake, Jr., editor},
|
---|
5584 | }
|
---|
5585 |
|
---|
5586 | % Q
|
---|
5587 |
|
---|
5588 | @article{Grossman06,
|
---|
5589 | keywords = {Cyclone, existential types, polymorphism, type variables},
|
---|
5590 | contributer = {a3moss@plg},
|
---|
5591 | author = {Grossman, Dan},
|
---|
5592 | title = {Quantified Types in an Imperative Language},
|
---|
5593 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
5594 | issue_date = {May 2006},
|
---|
5595 | volume = {28},
|
---|
5596 | number = {3},
|
---|
5597 | month = may,
|
---|
5598 | year = {2006},
|
---|
5599 | issn = {0164-0925},
|
---|
5600 | pages = {429--475},
|
---|
5601 | numpages = {47},
|
---|
5602 | url = {http://doi.acm.org.proxy.lib.uwaterloo.ca/10.1145/1133651.1133653},
|
---|
5603 | doi = {10.1145/1133651.1133653},
|
---|
5604 | acmid = {1133653},
|
---|
5605 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
5606 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
5607 | }
|
---|
5608 |
|
---|
5609 | @article{Hoare61,
|
---|
5610 | keywords = {quick sort},
|
---|
5611 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5612 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare},
|
---|
5613 | title = {Algorithms 63/64: Partition/Quicksort},
|
---|
5614 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
5615 | volume = 4,
|
---|
5616 | number = 7,
|
---|
5617 | month = jul,
|
---|
5618 | year = 1961,
|
---|
5619 | pages = {321},
|
---|
5620 | }
|
---|
5621 |
|
---|
5622 | % R
|
---|
5623 |
|
---|
5624 | @article{Ada:rationale:preliminary,
|
---|
5625 | keywords = {Ada},
|
---|
5626 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5627 | author = {J. D. Ichbiah and J. C. Heliard and O. Roubine and
|
---|
5628 | J. G. P. Barnes and B. Krieg-Brueckner and B. A. Wichmann},
|
---|
5629 | title = {Rationale for the Design of the {ADA} Programming Language},
|
---|
5630 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5631 | volume = 14,
|
---|
5632 | number = 6,
|
---|
5633 | month = jun,
|
---|
5634 | year = 1979,
|
---|
5635 | note = {Part B},
|
---|
5636 | }
|
---|
5637 |
|
---|
5638 | @book{Ada:rationale,
|
---|
5639 | keywords = {Ada},
|
---|
5640 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5641 | author = {Jean D. Ichbiah and John G. P. Barnes and Robert J. Firth and Mike Woodger},
|
---|
5642 | title = {Rationale for the Design of the {ADA} Programming Language},
|
---|
5643 | publisher = {Under Secretary of Defense, Research and Engineering},
|
---|
5644 | year = 1986,
|
---|
5645 | address = {Ada Joint Program Office, OUSDRE(R\&AT), The Pentagon, Washington, D. C., 20301, U.S.A.},
|
---|
5646 | }
|
---|
5647 |
|
---|
5648 | @manual{Ada95,
|
---|
5649 | keywords = {Ada},
|
---|
5650 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5651 | title = {{A}da Reference Manual},
|
---|
5652 | edition = {International Standard {ISO}/{IEC} {8652:1995(E)} with {COR.1:2000}},
|
---|
5653 | organization= {Intermetrics, Inc.},
|
---|
5654 | month = dec,
|
---|
5655 | year = 1995,
|
---|
5656 | note = {Language and Standards Libraries}
|
---|
5657 | }
|
---|
5658 |
|
---|
5659 | @manual{Ada12,
|
---|
5660 | keywords = {Ada},
|
---|
5661 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5662 | title = {Programming languages -- {Ada}},
|
---|
5663 | edition = {3rd},
|
---|
5664 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 1989:2014},
|
---|
5665 | publisher = {International Standard Organization},
|
---|
5666 | address = {http://www.iso.org},
|
---|
5667 | year = 2012,
|
---|
5668 | }
|
---|
5669 |
|
---|
5670 | @manual{Ada95:annotated,
|
---|
5671 | keywords = {Ada},
|
---|
5672 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5673 | title = {Annotated {A}da Reference Manual},
|
---|
5674 | edition = {International Standard {ISO}/{IEC} {8652:1995(E)} with {COR.1:2000}},
|
---|
5675 | organization = {Intermetrics, Inc.},
|
---|
5676 | month = dec,
|
---|
5677 | year = 1995,
|
---|
5678 | note = {Language and Standards Libraries}
|
---|
5679 | }
|
---|
5680 |
|
---|
5681 | @book{JavaRT00,
|
---|
5682 | keywords = {real time, draft},
|
---|
5683 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5684 | author = {Greg Bollella and Ben Brosgol and Peter Dibble and Steve Furr and James Gosling and David Hardin and Mark Turnbull},
|
---|
5685 | title = {The Real-Time Specification for {J}ava},
|
---|
5686 | series = {The Real-Time for Java Expert Group, {\small\textsf{http://\-www.rtj.org}}},
|
---|
5687 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
5688 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
5689 | year = 2000,
|
---|
5690 | }
|
---|
5691 |
|
---|
5692 | @manual{JavaRT99,
|
---|
5693 | organization= {Real Time for Java Experts Group},
|
---|
5694 | address = {{\small\textsf{http://\-www.rtj.org}}},
|
---|
5695 | month = sep,
|
---|
5696 | year = 1999,
|
---|
5697 | }
|
---|
5698 |
|
---|
5699 | @article{Robinson48,
|
---|
5700 | keywords = {recursion, Ackermann function},
|
---|
5701 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5702 | author = {Raphael Mitchel Robinson},
|
---|
5703 | title = {Recursion and Double Recursion},
|
---|
5704 | publisher = {American Mathematical Society},
|
---|
5705 | journal = {Bulletin of the American Mathematical Society},
|
---|
5706 | volume = 54,
|
---|
5707 | pages = {987-993},
|
---|
5708 | year = 1948,
|
---|
5709 | }
|
---|
5710 |
|
---|
5711 | @article{Dijkstra:red,
|
---|
5712 | keywords = {ada},
|
---|
5713 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5714 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
5715 | title = {On the RED Language submitted to the DoD},
|
---|
5716 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5717 | year = 1978,
|
---|
5718 | month = oct,
|
---|
5719 | volume = 13,
|
---|
5720 | number = 10,
|
---|
5721 | pages = {27-32},
|
---|
5722 | }
|
---|
5723 |
|
---|
5724 | @article{RemoteRendezvous,
|
---|
5725 | keywords = {rendezvous, concurrency},
|
---|
5726 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5727 | author = {N. D. Gammage and R. F. Kamel and L. M. Casey},
|
---|
5728 | title = {Remote Rendezvous},
|
---|
5729 | journal = spe,
|
---|
5730 | month = oct,
|
---|
5731 | year = 1987,
|
---|
5732 | volume = 17,
|
---|
5733 | number = 10,
|
---|
5734 | pages = {741-755}
|
---|
5735 | }
|
---|
5736 |
|
---|
5737 | @article{Euclid,
|
---|
5738 | keywords = {Euclid},
|
---|
5739 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5740 | author = {B. W. Lampson and J. J. Horning and R. L. London and J. G. Mitchell and G. L. Popek},
|
---|
5741 | title = {Report on the Programming Language Euclid},
|
---|
5742 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5743 | volume = 12,
|
---|
5744 | number = 2,
|
---|
5745 | month = feb,
|
---|
5746 | year = 1977,
|
---|
5747 | pages = {1-79}
|
---|
5748 | }
|
---|
5749 |
|
---|
5750 | @techreport{LOGLAN88,
|
---|
5751 | keywords = {LOGLAN},
|
---|
5752 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5753 | author = {Boleslaw Ciesielski and Antoni Kreczmar and Marek Lao and Andrzej Litwiniuk and Teresa Przytycka and Andrzej Salwicki and Jolanta Warpechowska and Marek Warpechowski and Andrzej Szalas and Danuta Szczepanska--Wasersztrum},
|
---|
5754 | title = {Report on the Programming Language LOGLAN'88},
|
---|
5755 | institution = {Institute of Informatics, University of Warsaw},
|
---|
5756 | address = {Pkin 8th Floor, 00-901 Warsaw, Poland},
|
---|
5757 | number = {},
|
---|
5758 | month = dec,
|
---|
5759 | year = 1988,
|
---|
5760 | }
|
---|
5761 |
|
---|
5762 | @article{FH91,
|
---|
5763 | keywords = {lcc},
|
---|
5764 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5765 | author = {Christopher W. Fraser and David R. Hanson},
|
---|
5766 | title = {A Retargetable Compiler for {ANSI} {C}},
|
---|
5767 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5768 | year = 1991,
|
---|
5769 | month = oct, volume = 26, number = 10, pages = {29-43},
|
---|
5770 | abstract = {
|
---|
5771 | {\tt lcc} is a new retargetable compiler for ANSI C. Versions for
|
---|
5772 | the VAX, Motorola 68020, SPARC, and MIPS are in production use at
|
---|
5773 | Princeton University and at AT\&T Bell Laboratories. With a few
|
---|
5774 | exceptions, little about {\tt lcc} is unusual---it integrates
|
---|
5775 | several well engineered, existing techniques---but it is smaller
|
---|
5776 | and faster than most other C compilers, and it generates code of
|
---|
5777 | comparable quality. {\tt lcc}'s target-independent front end
|
---|
5778 | performs a few simple, but effective, optimizations that contribute
|
---|
5779 | to good code; examples include simulating register declarations and
|
---|
5780 | partitioning switch statements into dense tables. It also
|
---|
5781 | implements target-independent function tracing and expression-level
|
---|
5782 | profiling.
|
---|
5783 | }
|
---|
5784 | }
|
---|
5785 |
|
---|
5786 | @article{Algol68revised,
|
---|
5787 | keywords = {},
|
---|
5788 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5789 | author = {A. van Wijngaarden and B. J. Mailloux and J. E. L. Peck and
|
---|
5790 | C. H. A. Koster and M. Sintzoff and C. H. Lindsey and L. G. L. T.
|
---|
5791 | Meertens and R. G. Fisher},
|
---|
5792 | title = {Revised Report on the Algorithmic Language {ALGOL} 68},
|
---|
5793 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5794 | year = 1977,
|
---|
5795 | month = may,
|
---|
5796 | volume = 12,
|
---|
5797 | number = 5,
|
---|
5798 | pages = {1-70}
|
---|
5799 | }
|
---|
5800 |
|
---|
5801 | @article{scheme,
|
---|
5802 | keywords = {},
|
---|
5803 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5804 | author = {Jonathan Rees and William Clinger},
|
---|
5805 | title = {Revised$^3$ Report on the Algorithmic Language {S}cheme},
|
---|
5806 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5807 | year = 1986,
|
---|
5808 | month = dec,
|
---|
5809 | volume = 21,
|
---|
5810 | number = 12,
|
---|
5811 | pages = {37-79},
|
---|
5812 | }
|
---|
5813 |
|
---|
5814 | @article{scheme5,
|
---|
5815 | keywords = {scheme},
|
---|
5816 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5817 | author = {H. Abelson and Adams, IV, N. I. and D. H. Bartley and G. Brooks and R. K. Dybvig and D. P. Friedman and
|
---|
5818 | R. Halstead and C. Hanson and C. T. Haynes and E. Kohlbecker and D. Oxley and K. M. Pitman and G. J. Rozas and
|
---|
5819 | G. L. Steele Jr. and G. J. Sussman and M. Wand and \emph{Ed. by} Richard Kelsey and William Clinger and Jonathan Rees},
|
---|
5820 | title = {Revised$^5$ Report on the Algorithmic Language {S}cheme},
|
---|
5821 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
5822 | year = 1998,
|
---|
5823 | month = sep,
|
---|
5824 | volume = 33,
|
---|
5825 | number = 9,
|
---|
5826 | pages = {26-76},
|
---|
5827 | }
|
---|
5828 |
|
---|
5829 | @manual{Rust,
|
---|
5830 | keywords = {Rust programming language},
|
---|
5831 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5832 | title = {The {Rust} Programming Language},
|
---|
5833 | organization= {The Rust Project Developers},
|
---|
5834 | year = 2015,
|
---|
5835 | note = {\href{https://doc.rust-lang.org/reference.html}{https://\-doc.rust-lang.org/\-reference.html}},
|
---|
5836 | }
|
---|
5837 |
|
---|
5838 | % S
|
---|
5839 |
|
---|
5840 | @manual{Scala,
|
---|
5841 | keywords = {Scala programming language},
|
---|
5842 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5843 | title = {{Scala} Language Specification, Version 2.11},
|
---|
5844 | organization= {\'{E}cole Polytechnique F\'{e}d\'{e}rale de Lausanne},
|
---|
5845 | year = 2016,
|
---|
5846 | note = {\href{http://www.scala-lang.org/files/archive/spec/2.11}{http://\-www.scala-lang.org/\-files/\-archive/\-spec/\-2.11}},
|
---|
5847 | }
|
---|
5848 |
|
---|
5849 | @inproceedings{Michael04,
|
---|
5850 | keywords = {lock free, dynamic memory allocation},
|
---|
5851 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5852 | author = {Maged M. Michael},
|
---|
5853 | title = {Scalable Lock-free Dynamic Memory Allocation},
|
---|
5854 | booktitle = {PLDI '04: Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN 2004 Conference on Programming Language Design and Implementation},
|
---|
5855 | location = {Washington DC, USA},
|
---|
5856 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
5857 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
5858 | volume = 39,
|
---|
5859 | year = 2004,
|
---|
5860 | month = jun,
|
---|
5861 | pages = {35-46},
|
---|
5862 | }
|
---|
5863 |
|
---|
5864 | @article{Anderson92,
|
---|
5865 | keywords = {light-weight tasks},
|
---|
5866 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5867 | author = {Thomas E. Anderson and Brian N. Bershad and Edward D. Lazowska and Henry M. Levy},
|
---|
5868 | title = {Scheduler Activations: Effective Kernel Support for the User-Level Management of Parallelism},
|
---|
5869 | journal = tocs,
|
---|
5870 | volume = 10,
|
---|
5871 | number = 1,
|
---|
5872 | month = feb,
|
---|
5873 | year = 1992,
|
---|
5874 | pages = {53-79},
|
---|
5875 | }
|
---|
5876 |
|
---|
5877 | @manual{SELF,
|
---|
5878 | keywords = {programming language, obect-oriented, polymorphism},
|
---|
5879 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5880 | author = {Ole Agesen and Lars Bak and Craig Chambers and Bay-Wei Chang and Urs H{\o}lzle
|
---|
5881 | and John H. Maloney and Randall B. Smith and David Ungar and Mario Wolczko},
|
---|
5882 | title = {The {SELF} 3.0 Programmer's Reference Manual},
|
---|
5883 | organization= {Sun Microsystems, Inc., and Stanford University},
|
---|
5884 | year = 1993,
|
---|
5885 | }
|
---|
5886 |
|
---|
5887 | @inproceedings{Cardelli84,
|
---|
5888 | keywords = {subtypes, recursive types, records, variants, object oriented},
|
---|
5889 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
5890 | author = {Luca Cardelli},
|
---|
5891 | title = {A Semantics of Multiple Inheritance},
|
---|
5892 | booktitle = {Semantics of Data Types},
|
---|
5893 | year = 1984,
|
---|
5894 | pages = {51-67},
|
---|
5895 | editor = {G. Kahn and D. B. MacQueen and G. D. Plotkin},
|
---|
5896 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
5897 | note = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science v. 173},
|
---|
5898 | }
|
---|
5899 |
|
---|
5900 | @techreport{Adve95,
|
---|
5901 | keywords = {shared memory, consistency models},
|
---|
5902 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5903 | author = {Sarita V. Adve and Kourosh Gharachorloo},
|
---|
5904 | title = {Shared Memory Consistency Models: A Tutorial},
|
---|
5905 | institution = {Western Research Laboratory},
|
---|
5906 | address = {250 University Avenue, Palo Alto, California, 94301, U.S.A.},
|
---|
5907 | number = {7},
|
---|
5908 | month = sep,
|
---|
5909 | year = 1995,
|
---|
5910 | note = {\href{http://www.hpl.hp.com/techreports/Compaq-DEC/WRL-95-7.pdf}{\textsf{http://www.hpl.hp.com/\-techreports/\-Compaq-DEC/\-WRL-95-7.pdf}}, Reprinted in \cite{Adve95reprint}.},
|
---|
5911 | }
|
---|
5912 |
|
---|
5913 | @article{Adve95reprint,
|
---|
5914 | keywords = {shared memory, consistency models},
|
---|
5915 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5916 | author = {Sarita V. Adve and Kourosh Gharachorloo},
|
---|
5917 | journal = {Computer},
|
---|
5918 | title = {Shared Memory Consistency Models: A Tutorial},
|
---|
5919 | month = dec,
|
---|
5920 | year = 1996,
|
---|
5921 | volume = 29,
|
---|
5922 | number = 12,
|
---|
5923 | pages = {66-76},
|
---|
5924 | }
|
---|
5925 |
|
---|
5926 | @inproceedings{Howard76b,
|
---|
5927 | keywords = {monitors},
|
---|
5928 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5929 | author = {J. H. Howard},
|
---|
5930 | title = {Signaling in Monitors},
|
---|
5931 | booktitle = {Proceedings Second International Conference Software Engineering},
|
---|
5932 | address = {San Francisco, U.S.A},
|
---|
5933 | publisher = {IEEE Computer Society},
|
---|
5934 | month = oct,
|
---|
5935 | year = 1976,
|
---|
5936 | pages = {47-52}
|
---|
5937 | }
|
---|
5938 |
|
---|
5939 | @techreport{Schemenauer01,
|
---|
5940 | keywords = {Phthon, generator, coroutine},
|
---|
5941 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5942 | author = {Neil Schemenauer and Tim Peters and Magnus Lie Hetland},
|
---|
5943 | title = {Simple Generators},
|
---|
5944 | month = may,
|
---|
5945 | year = 2001,
|
---|
5946 | note = {\href{http://www.python.org/peps/pep-0255.html}{http://\-www.python.org/\-peps/\-pep-0255.html}},
|
---|
5947 | }
|
---|
5948 |
|
---|
5949 | @inproceedings{Michael96,
|
---|
5950 | keywords = {compare_and_swap, concurrent queue, lock-free, multiprogramming, non-blocking},
|
---|
5951 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
5952 | author = {Maged M. Michael and Michael L. Scott},
|
---|
5953 | title = {Simple, Fast, and Practical Non-blocking and Blocking Concurrent Queue Algorithms},
|
---|
5954 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Fifteenth Annual ACM Symposium on Principles of Distributed Computing},
|
---|
5955 | series = {PODC'96},
|
---|
5956 | year = 1996,
|
---|
5957 | location = {Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, USA},
|
---|
5958 | pages = {267--275},
|
---|
5959 | numpages = {9},
|
---|
5960 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
5961 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
5962 | }
|
---|
5963 |
|
---|
5964 | @article{Pennello80,
|
---|
5965 | contributer = {a3moss@uwaterloo.ca},
|
---|
5966 | author = {Pennello, Tom and DeRemer, Frank and Meyers, Richard},
|
---|
5967 | title = {A Simplified Operator Identification Scheme for {Ada}},
|
---|
5968 | journal = {SIGPLAN Notices},
|
---|
5969 | issue_date = {July-August 1980},
|
---|
5970 | volume = {15},
|
---|
5971 | number = {7 and 8},
|
---|
5972 | month = jul,
|
---|
5973 | year = {1980},
|
---|
5974 | issn = {0362-1340},
|
---|
5975 | pages = {82--87},
|
---|
5976 | numpages = {6},
|
---|
5977 | url = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/947680.947688},
|
---|
5978 | doi = {10.1145/947680.947688},
|
---|
5979 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
5980 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
5981 | }
|
---|
5982 |
|
---|
5983 | @inproceedings{Dice10,
|
---|
5984 | keywords = {hardware, synchronization, transactional memory},
|
---|
5985 | author = {Dave Dice and Yossi Lev and Virendra J. Marathe and Mark Moir and Dan Nussbaum and Marek Olszewski},
|
---|
5986 | title = {Simplifying Concurrent Algorithms by Exploiting Hardware Transactional Memory},
|
---|
5987 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Twenty-second Annual ACM Symposium on Parallelism in Algorithms and Architectures},
|
---|
5988 | series = {SPAA'10},
|
---|
5989 | year = 2010,
|
---|
5990 | location = {Thira, Santorini, Greece},
|
---|
5991 | pages = {325-334},
|
---|
5992 | numpages = {10},
|
---|
5993 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
5994 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
5995 | }
|
---|
5996 |
|
---|
5997 | @article{PDM:overload,
|
---|
5998 | keywords = {compilation},
|
---|
5999 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6000 | author = {Tom Pennello and Frank DeRemer and Richard Meyers},
|
---|
6001 | title = {A Simplified Operator Identification Scheme for {Ada}},
|
---|
6002 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
6003 | year = 1980,
|
---|
6004 | month = {July--August},
|
---|
6005 | volume = 15,
|
---|
6006 | number = {7/8},
|
---|
6007 | pages = {82-87},
|
---|
6008 | comment = {
|
---|
6009 | The two-pass (bottom-up, top-down) overload resolution algorithm
|
---|
6010 | for Ada, with a proof that two passes suffice and a claim that two
|
---|
6011 | are necessary. See \cite{D:overload}.
|
---|
6012 | }
|
---|
6013 | }
|
---|
6014 |
|
---|
6015 | @book{SimulaBegin,
|
---|
6016 | author = {Graham M. Birtwistle and Ole-Johan Dahl and Bj{\o}rn Myhrhaug and Kristen Nygaard},
|
---|
6017 | title = {{SIMULA} begin},
|
---|
6018 | publisher = {Studentlitteratur},
|
---|
6019 | year = {1980},
|
---|
6020 | address = {Lund, Sweden},
|
---|
6021 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
6022 | }
|
---|
6023 |
|
---|
6024 | @book{Simula67,
|
---|
6025 | author = {O-J Dahl and B. Myhrhaug and K. Nygaard},
|
---|
6026 | title = {Simula67 Common Base Language},
|
---|
6027 | month = oct,
|
---|
6028 | year = 1970,
|
---|
6029 | publisher = {Norwegian Com\-puting Center},
|
---|
6030 | address = {Oslo Norway},
|
---|
6031 | }
|
---|
6032 |
|
---|
6033 | @book{smalltalk,
|
---|
6034 | keywords = {Smalltalk, abstract class, protocol},
|
---|
6035 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6036 | author = {A. Goldberg and D. Robson},
|
---|
6037 | title = {Smalltalk-80: The Language and its Implementation},
|
---|
6038 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
6039 | address = {Reading},
|
---|
6040 | year = 1983
|
---|
6041 | }
|
---|
6042 |
|
---|
6043 | @inproceedings{Edelson92,
|
---|
6044 | keywords = {persistence, pointers},
|
---|
6045 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6046 | author = {Daniel R. Edelson},
|
---|
6047 | title = {Smart Pointers: They're Smart, but They're Not Pointers},
|
---|
6048 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Technical Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
6049 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
6050 | address = {Portland, Oregon, U.S.A.},
|
---|
6051 | month = aug,
|
---|
6052 | year = 1992,
|
---|
6053 | pages = {1-19},
|
---|
6054 | }
|
---|
6055 |
|
---|
6056 | @book{SNOBOL,
|
---|
6057 | keywords = {SNOBOL4},
|
---|
6058 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6059 | author = {R. E. Griswold and J. F. Poage and I. P. Polonsky},
|
---|
6060 | title = {The SNOBOL4 Programming Language},
|
---|
6061 | edition = {2nd},
|
---|
6062 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
6063 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
6064 | year = 1971,
|
---|
6065 | }
|
---|
6066 |
|
---|
6067 | @article{Sutter05b,
|
---|
6068 | keywords = {concurrency},
|
---|
6069 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6070 | author = {Herb Sutter and James Larus},
|
---|
6071 | title = {Software and the Concurrency Revolution},
|
---|
6072 | journal = Queue,
|
---|
6073 | year = 2005,
|
---|
6074 | month = sep,
|
---|
6075 | volume = 3,
|
---|
6076 | number = 7,
|
---|
6077 | pages = {54-62},
|
---|
6078 | }
|
---|
6079 |
|
---|
6080 | @inproceedings{raytheon,
|
---|
6081 | keywords = {cobol},
|
---|
6082 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6083 | author = {Robert G. Lanergan and Charles A. Grasso},
|
---|
6084 | title = {Software Engineering with Reusable Designs and Code},
|
---|
6085 | booktitle = {Workshop on Reusability in Programming},
|
---|
6086 | year = 1983,
|
---|
6087 | month = sep,
|
---|
6088 | pages = {224-234},
|
---|
6089 | organization= {{ITT} Programming},
|
---|
6090 | summary = {
|
---|
6091 | 60\% of business application design and code are redundant.
|
---|
6092 | Three standard program plans are used. Reuse doubles productivity
|
---|
6093 | during development and greatly helps program comprehension during
|
---|
6094 | maintenance.
|
---|
6095 | }
|
---|
6096 | }
|
---|
6097 |
|
---|
6098 | @article{Hecht86,
|
---|
6099 | keywords = {exception handling, robustness},
|
---|
6100 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6101 | author = {H. Hecht and M. Hecht},
|
---|
6102 | title = {Software Reliability in the Systems Context},
|
---|
6103 | journal = ieeese,
|
---|
6104 | year = 1986,
|
---|
6105 | volume = 12,
|
---|
6106 | number = 1,
|
---|
6107 | pages = {51-58},
|
---|
6108 | }
|
---|
6109 |
|
---|
6110 | @inproceedings{Herlihy03,
|
---|
6111 | author = {Maurice Herlihy and Victor Luchangco and Mark Moir and William N. {Scherer III}},
|
---|
6112 | title = {Software Transactional Memory for Dynamic-sized Data Structures},
|
---|
6113 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Twenty-second Annual Symposium on Principles of Distributed Computing},
|
---|
6114 | series = {PODC '03},
|
---|
6115 | year = {2003},
|
---|
6116 | location = {Boston, Massachusetts},
|
---|
6117 | pages = {92-101},
|
---|
6118 | numpages = {10},
|
---|
6119 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
6120 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
6121 | }
|
---|
6122 |
|
---|
6123 | @article{Dijkstra65a,
|
---|
6124 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion},
|
---|
6125 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6126 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
6127 | title = {Solution of a Problem in Concurrent Programming Control},
|
---|
6128 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
6129 | volume = 8,
|
---|
6130 | number = 9,
|
---|
6131 | month = sep,
|
---|
6132 | year = 1965,
|
---|
6133 | pages = {569},
|
---|
6134 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
6135 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
6136 | }
|
---|
6137 |
|
---|
6138 | @inproceedings{Chen05,
|
---|
6139 | keywords = {fixed-priority, preemption},
|
---|
6140 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6141 | author = {Jiongxiong Chen and Ashif Harji and Peter Buhr},
|
---|
6142 | title = {Solution Space for Fixed-Priority with Preemption Threshold},
|
---|
6143 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 11th Real Time and Embedded Technology and Applications Symposium (RTAS'05)},
|
---|
6144 | organization= {IEEE},
|
---|
6145 | address = {San Francisco, CA, U.S.A},
|
---|
6146 | month = mar,
|
---|
6147 | year = 2005,
|
---|
6148 | pages = {385-394}
|
---|
6149 | }
|
---|
6150 |
|
---|
6151 | @inproceedings{Tiemann88,
|
---|
6152 | keywords = {wrappers},
|
---|
6153 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6154 | author = {Michael D. Tiemann},
|
---|
6155 | title = {Solving the RPC problem in GNU {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
6156 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference},
|
---|
6157 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
6158 | address = {Denver, Colorado, U.S.A},
|
---|
6159 | month = oct,
|
---|
6160 | year = 1988,
|
---|
6161 | pages = {343-361}
|
---|
6162 | }
|
---|
6163 |
|
---|
6164 | @book{Campbell74,
|
---|
6165 | keywords = {path expressions},
|
---|
6166 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6167 | author = {R. H. Campbell and A. N. Habermann},
|
---|
6168 | title = {The Specification of Process Synchronization by Path Expressions},
|
---|
6169 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
6170 | year = 1974,
|
---|
6171 | volume = 16,
|
---|
6172 | pages = {89-102},
|
---|
6173 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
6174 | }
|
---|
6175 |
|
---|
6176 | @article{Bentley85,
|
---|
6177 | keywords = {CSP, concurrency},
|
---|
6178 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6179 | author = {J. Bentley},
|
---|
6180 | title = {A Spelling Checker},
|
---|
6181 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
6182 | month = may,
|
---|
6183 | year = 1985,
|
---|
6184 | volume = 28,
|
---|
6185 | number = 5,
|
---|
6186 | pages = {456-462},
|
---|
6187 | }
|
---|
6188 |
|
---|
6189 | @manual{POSIX01,
|
---|
6190 | keywords = {POSIX, Standard},
|
---|
6191 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6192 | key = {POSIX},
|
---|
6193 | title = {1003.1 Standard for Information Technology -- Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX), System Interface, Issue 6},
|
---|
6194 | organization= {IEEE and The Open Group},
|
---|
6195 | year = 2001,
|
---|
6196 | }
|
---|
6197 |
|
---|
6198 | @manual{POSIX08,
|
---|
6199 | keywords = {POSIX, Standard},
|
---|
6200 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6201 | key = {POSIX},
|
---|
6202 | title = {1003.1 Standard for Information Technology -- Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX), Base Specifications, Issue 7},
|
---|
6203 | organization= {IEEE and The Open Group},
|
---|
6204 | year = 2008,
|
---|
6205 | }
|
---|
6206 |
|
---|
6207 | @inproceedings{ML:NJ,
|
---|
6208 | keywords = {continuations, ML},
|
---|
6209 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6210 | author = {A. Appel and D. MacQueen},
|
---|
6211 | title = {A Standard {ML} Compiler},
|
---|
6212 | booktitle = {Functional Programming Languages and Computer Architecture},
|
---|
6213 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
6214 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
6215 | volume = 274,
|
---|
6216 | year = 1987,
|
---|
6217 | pages = {301-324},
|
---|
6218 | }
|
---|
6219 |
|
---|
6220 | @techreport{MLreport,
|
---|
6221 | keywords = {ML, polymorphism},
|
---|
6222 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6223 | author = {R. Milner},
|
---|
6224 | title = {The Standard {ML} Core Language},
|
---|
6225 | institution = {},
|
---|
6226 | number = {Polymorphism II.2},
|
---|
6227 | month = oct,
|
---|
6228 | year = 1985
|
---|
6229 | }
|
---|
6230 |
|
---|
6231 | @inproceedings{Ghelli,
|
---|
6232 | keywords = {},
|
---|
6233 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6234 | author = {Giorgio Ghelli},
|
---|
6235 | title = {A Static Type System for Message Passing},
|
---|
6236 | crossref = "OOPSLA91",
|
---|
6237 | pages = {129-145},
|
---|
6238 | summary = {
|
---|
6239 | A strong, statically checked type system for object oriented
|
---|
6240 | languages is defined by modelling methods as overloaded functions
|
---|
6241 | with a "self" parameter, with dynamic overload resolution. This
|
---|
6242 | allows covariant method redefinition. However, if equality is
|
---|
6243 | covariantly redefined for Point and ColoredPoint classes, and a
|
---|
6244 | ColoredPoint is compared to a Point, Point equality will be used,
|
---|
6245 | even if self is the colored point!
|
---|
6246 | }
|
---|
6247 | }
|
---|
6248 |
|
---|
6249 | @article{Dijkstra68b,
|
---|
6250 | keywords = {semaphore, P/V},
|
---|
6251 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6252 | author = {E. W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
6253 | title = {The Structure of the ``{THE}''--Multiprogramming System},
|
---|
6254 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
6255 | month = may,
|
---|
6256 | year = 1968,
|
---|
6257 | volume = 11,
|
---|
6258 | number = 5,
|
---|
6259 | pages = {341-346}
|
---|
6260 | }
|
---|
6261 |
|
---|
6262 | @book{Holt78,
|
---|
6263 | keywords = {operating systems, concurrency},
|
---|
6264 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6265 | author = {R. C. Holt and G. S. Graham and E. D. Lazowska and M. A. Scott},
|
---|
6266 | title = {Structured Concurrent Programming with Operating System Applications},
|
---|
6267 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley},
|
---|
6268 | address = {Boston},
|
---|
6269 | year = 1978,
|
---|
6270 | }
|
---|
6271 |
|
---|
6272 | @article{Stevens74,
|
---|
6273 | keywords = {coupling, cohesion},
|
---|
6274 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6275 | author = {W. P. Stevens and and G. J. Myers and L. L. Constantine},
|
---|
6276 | title = {Structured Design},
|
---|
6277 | journal = ibmsj,
|
---|
6278 | year = 1974,
|
---|
6279 | volume = 13,
|
---|
6280 | number = 2,
|
---|
6281 | pages = {115-139},
|
---|
6282 | }
|
---|
6283 |
|
---|
6284 | @article{Hansen72b,
|
---|
6285 | keywords = {critical region},
|
---|
6286 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6287 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}},
|
---|
6288 | title = {Structured Multiprogramming},
|
---|
6289 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
6290 | volume = 15,
|
---|
6291 | number = 7,
|
---|
6292 | month = jul,
|
---|
6293 | year = 1972,
|
---|
6294 | pages = {574-578},
|
---|
6295 | }
|
---|
6296 |
|
---|
6297 | @article{Knuth74,
|
---|
6298 | keywords = {structured programming, goto statement},
|
---|
6299 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6300 | author = {Donald E. Knuth},
|
---|
6301 | title = {Structured Programming with go to Statements},
|
---|
6302 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
6303 | volume = 6,
|
---|
6304 | number = 4,
|
---|
6305 | month = dec,
|
---|
6306 | year = 1974,
|
---|
6307 | pages = {261-301},
|
---|
6308 | issn = {0360-0300},
|
---|
6309 | doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/356635.356640},
|
---|
6310 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
6311 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
6312 | }
|
---|
6313 |
|
---|
6314 | @article{Lang98,
|
---|
6315 | keywords = {real-time, exception handling},
|
---|
6316 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6317 | author = {Jun Lang and David B. Stewart},
|
---|
6318 | title = {A Study of the Applicability of Existing Exception-Handling Techniques to Component-Based Real-Time Software Technology},
|
---|
6319 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
6320 | month = mar,
|
---|
6321 | year = 1998,
|
---|
6322 | volume = 20,
|
---|
6323 | number = 2,
|
---|
6324 | pages = {274-301},
|
---|
6325 | }
|
---|
6326 |
|
---|
6327 | @mastersthesis{Fortier89,
|
---|
6328 | keywords = {monitors},
|
---|
6329 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6330 | author = {Michel Fortier},
|
---|
6331 | title = {Study of Monitors},
|
---|
6332 | school = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
6333 | year = 1989,
|
---|
6334 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
6335 | }
|
---|
6336 |
|
---|
6337 | @techreport{AmadioCardelli,
|
---|
6338 | keywords = {},
|
---|
6339 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6340 | author = {Roberto M. Amadio and Luca Cardelli},
|
---|
6341 | title = {Subtyping Recursive Types},
|
---|
6342 | institution = {Digital Equipment Corporation Systems Research Center},
|
---|
6343 | year = 1990,
|
---|
6344 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, California 94301},
|
---|
6345 | month = aug,
|
---|
6346 | number = 62,
|
---|
6347 | summary = {
|
---|
6348 | \[ (s \leq t \Rightarrow \alpha \leq \beta) \Rightarrow
|
---|
6349 | \mu s.\alpha leq \mu t.\beta \]
|
---|
6350 | \[ \alpha = C[\alpha] \and \beta = C[\beta] \and C contractive
|
---|
6351 | \Rightarrow \alpha = \beta \]
|
---|
6352 | where a type \(\alpha\) is contractive in the type variable \(t\)
|
---|
6353 | if either \(t\) does not occur free in \(\alpha\), or \(\alpha\)
|
---|
6354 | can be rewritten via unfolding as a type of the shape
|
---|
6355 | \(\alpha_1 \rightarrow \alpha_2\), and unfolding rewrites
|
---|
6356 | \(\mu t.\alpha\) as \([t\leftarrow\mu t.\alpha]\alpha\). An
|
---|
6357 | algorithm for finding type contexts \(C\) is given.
|
---|
6358 | }
|
---|
6359 | }
|
---|
6360 |
|
---|
6361 | @techreport{Dijkstra80,
|
---|
6362 | keywords = {split binary semaphores, general to binary},
|
---|
6363 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6364 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
6365 | title = {The Superfluity of the General Semaphore},
|
---|
6366 | institution = {Nuenen},
|
---|
6367 | address = {Netherlands},
|
---|
6368 | number = {EWD734},
|
---|
6369 | month = apr,
|
---|
6370 | year = 1980,
|
---|
6371 | }
|
---|
6372 |
|
---|
6373 | @inproceedings{Burns81,
|
---|
6374 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion},
|
---|
6375 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6376 | author = {James E. Burns},
|
---|
6377 | title = {Symmetry in Systems of Asynchronous Processes},
|
---|
6378 | booktitle = {22nd Annual Symposium on Foundations of Computer Science, Nashville, TN, USA},
|
---|
6379 | year = 1981,
|
---|
6380 | month = oct,
|
---|
6381 | organization= {IEEE Computer Society},
|
---|
6382 | address = {Los Angeles, CA, USA},
|
---|
6383 | pages = {169-174},
|
---|
6384 | }
|
---|
6385 |
|
---|
6386 | @article{Coffman71,
|
---|
6387 | keywords = {deadlock},
|
---|
6388 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6389 | author = {E. G. {Coffman, Jr.} and M. J. Elphick and A. Shoshani},
|
---|
6390 | title = {System Deadlocks},
|
---|
6391 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
6392 | volume = 3,
|
---|
6393 | number = 2,
|
---|
6394 | month = jun,
|
---|
6395 | year = 1971,
|
---|
6396 | pages = {67-78},
|
---|
6397 | publisher = {ACM Press},
|
---|
6398 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
6399 | doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/356586.356588},
|
---|
6400 | }
|
---|
6401 |
|
---|
6402 | @phdthesis{Holmes99,
|
---|
6403 | keywords = {synchronization, inheritance anomaly},
|
---|
6404 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6405 | author = {David Holmes},
|
---|
6406 | title = {Synchronisation Rings: Composable Synchronisation for Object-Oriented Systems},
|
---|
6407 | school = {Department of Computing, Macquarie University},
|
---|
6408 | month = oct,
|
---|
6409 | year = 1999,
|
---|
6410 | address = {Sydney, Australia},
|
---|
6411 | }
|
---|
6412 |
|
---|
6413 | @book{Taubenfeld06,
|
---|
6414 | keywords = {concurrency, synchronization},
|
---|
6415 | author = {Gadi Taubenfeld},
|
---|
6416 | title = {Synchronization Algorithms and Concurrent Programming},
|
---|
6417 | publisher = {Pearson/Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
6418 | address = {Harlow, England},
|
---|
6419 | year = 2006,
|
---|
6420 | }
|
---|
6421 |
|
---|
6422 | @article{Buhr92b,
|
---|
6423 | keywords = {concurrency, exception handling, interventions},
|
---|
6424 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6425 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Hamish I. Macdonald and C. Robert Zarnke},
|
---|
6426 | title = {Synchronous and Asynchronous Handling of Abnormal Events in the $\mu${S}ystem},
|
---|
6427 | journal = spe,
|
---|
6428 | volume = 22,
|
---|
6429 | number = 9,
|
---|
6430 | month = sep,
|
---|
6431 | year = 1992,
|
---|
6432 | pages = {735-776},
|
---|
6433 | }
|
---|
6434 |
|
---|
6435 | @inproceedings{Greenwald96,
|
---|
6436 | keywords = {compare and swap, hardware atomicity},
|
---|
6437 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6438 | author = {Michael Greenwald and David Cheriton},
|
---|
6439 | title = {The Synergy between Non-blocking Synchronization and Operating System Structure},
|
---|
6440 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Second USENIX Symposium on Operating Systems Design and Implementation},
|
---|
6441 | organization= {USENIX Association},
|
---|
6442 | address = {Seattle, Washington, U.S.A.},
|
---|
6443 | month = oct,
|
---|
6444 | year = 1996,
|
---|
6445 | pages = {123-136},
|
---|
6446 | }
|
---|
6447 |
|
---|
6448 | @inbook{SunLWP,
|
---|
6449 | keywords = {light-weight processes, threads},
|
---|
6450 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6451 | key = {Sun},
|
---|
6452 | title = {System Services Overview, Lightweight Processes},
|
---|
6453 | chapter = {6},
|
---|
6454 | pages = {71-111},
|
---|
6455 | publisher = {Sun Microsystems},
|
---|
6456 | month = may,
|
---|
6457 | year = 1988,
|
---|
6458 | note = {available as Part Number: 800-1753-10},
|
---|
6459 | }
|
---|
6460 |
|
---|
6461 | @article{Randell75,
|
---|
6462 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6463 | author = {Brian Randell},
|
---|
6464 | title = {System Structure for Software Fault Tolerance},
|
---|
6465 | journal = ieeese,
|
---|
6466 | volume = {SE-1},
|
---|
6467 | number = 2,
|
---|
6468 | month = jun,
|
---|
6469 | year = 1975,
|
---|
6470 | pages = {220-232},
|
---|
6471 | }
|
---|
6472 |
|
---|
6473 | @book{Modula-3,
|
---|
6474 | keywords = {language reference manual},
|
---|
6475 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6476 | author = {Andrew Birrell and Mark R. Brown and Luca Cardelli and Jim Donahue and Lucille Glassman and John Gutag and Jim Harning and Bill Kalsow and Roy Levin and Greg Nelson},
|
---|
6477 | title = {Systems Programming with Modula-3},
|
---|
6478 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall},
|
---|
6479 | address = {Englewood Cliffs},
|
---|
6480 | year = 1991,
|
---|
6481 | series = {Prentice-Hall Series in Innovative Technology}
|
---|
6482 | }
|
---|
6483 |
|
---|
6484 | % T
|
---|
6485 |
|
---|
6486 | @article{Yeager91,
|
---|
6487 | keywords = {teaching, concurrency},
|
---|
6488 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6489 | author = {Dorian P. Yeager},
|
---|
6490 | title = {Teaching Concurrency in the Programming Languages Course},
|
---|
6491 | journal = {SIGCSE BULLETIN},
|
---|
6492 | volume = 23,
|
---|
6493 | number = 1,
|
---|
6494 | month = mar,
|
---|
6495 | year = 1991,
|
---|
6496 | pages = {155-161},
|
---|
6497 | note = {The Papers of the Twenty-Second SIGCSE Technical Symposium on Computer Science Education,
|
---|
6498 | March. 7--8, 1991, San Antonio, Texas, U.S.A.},
|
---|
6499 | }
|
---|
6500 |
|
---|
6501 | @article{ml,
|
---|
6502 | keywords = {ML, polymorphism},
|
---|
6503 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6504 | author = {Robin Milner},
|
---|
6505 | title = {A Theory of Type Polymorphism in Programming},
|
---|
6506 | journal = jcss,
|
---|
6507 | year = 1978,
|
---|
6508 | volume = 17, pages = {348-375}
|
---|
6509 | }
|
---|
6510 |
|
---|
6511 | @book{Thoth,
|
---|
6512 | keywords = {messages, concurrency},
|
---|
6513 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6514 | author = {D. R. Cheriton},
|
---|
6515 | title = {The Thoth System: Multi-Process Structuring and Portability},
|
---|
6516 | publisher = {American Elsevier},
|
---|
6517 | year = 1982
|
---|
6518 | }
|
---|
6519 |
|
---|
6520 | @article{Boehm05,
|
---|
6521 | keywords = {concurrency, C++},
|
---|
6522 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6523 | author = {Hans-J. Boehm},
|
---|
6524 | title = {Threads Cannot be Implemented as a Library},
|
---|
6525 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
6526 | volume = 40,
|
---|
6527 | number = 6,
|
---|
6528 | month = jun,
|
---|
6529 | year = 2005,
|
---|
6530 | pages = {261-268},
|
---|
6531 | }
|
---|
6532 |
|
---|
6533 | @misc{Bumbulis90,
|
---|
6534 | keywords = {parameter inference, ForceN},
|
---|
6535 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6536 | author = {Peter Bumbulis},
|
---|
6537 | title = {Towards Making Signatures First-Class},
|
---|
6538 | howpublished= {personal communication},
|
---|
6539 | month = sep, year = 1990,
|
---|
6540 | note = {}
|
---|
6541 | }
|
---|
6542 |
|
---|
6543 | @techreport{alphard:preempt,
|
---|
6544 | keywords = {},
|
---|
6545 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6546 | author = {Mary Shaw and Wm. A. Wulf},
|
---|
6547 | title = {Toward Relaxing Assumptions in Languages and Their Implementations},
|
---|
6548 | institution = {Carnegie-Mellon University},
|
---|
6549 | year = 1980,
|
---|
6550 | month = jan,
|
---|
6551 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{alphard}.}
|
---|
6552 | }
|
---|
6553 |
|
---|
6554 | @inproceedings{Reynolds74,
|
---|
6555 | keywords = {universal quantification, typed lambda calculus},
|
---|
6556 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6557 | author = {John C. Reynolds},
|
---|
6558 | title = {Towards a Theory of Type Structure},
|
---|
6559 | booktitle = {Colloque sur la Programmation},
|
---|
6560 | year = 1974,
|
---|
6561 | pages = {408-423},
|
---|
6562 | editor = {B. Robinet},
|
---|
6563 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
6564 | note = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science, v. 19},
|
---|
6565 | abstract = {
|
---|
6566 |
|
---|
6567 | }
|
---|
6568 | }
|
---|
6569 |
|
---|
6570 | @incollection{Hoare72,
|
---|
6571 | keywords = {critical region, concurrency},
|
---|
6572 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6573 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare},
|
---|
6574 | title = {Towards a Theory of Parallel Programming},
|
---|
6575 | booktitle = {Operating Systems Techniques},
|
---|
6576 | editor = {C. A. R. Hoare and R. H. Perott},
|
---|
6577 | publisher = {Academic Press, New York},
|
---|
6578 | year = 1972,
|
---|
6579 | pages = {61-71},
|
---|
6580 | }
|
---|
6581 |
|
---|
6582 | @inproceedings{Mitchell90,
|
---|
6583 | keywords = {polymorphism, lambda calculus, bounded quantification},
|
---|
6584 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6585 | author = {John C. Mitchell},
|
---|
6586 | title = {Toward a Typed Foundation for Method Specialization and Inheritance},
|
---|
6587 | booktitle = {Conference Record of the Seventeenth Annual ACM Symposium
|
---|
6588 | on Principles of Programming Languages},
|
---|
6589 | year = 1990,
|
---|
6590 | month = jan, pages = {109-124},
|
---|
6591 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
6592 | abstract = {
|
---|
6593 | This paper disucsses the phenomenon of {\em method specialization}
|
---|
6594 | in object-oriented programming languages. A typed function
|
---|
6595 | calculus of objects and classes is presented, featuring method
|
---|
6596 | specialization when methods are added or redefined. The soundness
|
---|
6597 | of the typing rules (without subtyping) is suggested by a
|
---|
6598 | translation into a more traditional calculus with
|
---|
6599 | recursively-defined record types. However, semantic questions
|
---|
6600 | regarding the subtype relation on classes remain open.
|
---|
6601 | }
|
---|
6602 | }
|
---|
6603 |
|
---|
6604 | @article{EL1,
|
---|
6605 | keywords = {polymorphism},
|
---|
6606 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6607 | author = {B. Wegbreit},
|
---|
6608 | title = {The Treatment of Data Types in {EL1}},
|
---|
6609 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
6610 | volume = 17,
|
---|
6611 | number = 5,
|
---|
6612 | month = may,
|
---|
6613 | year = 1974,
|
---|
6614 | pages = {251-264},
|
---|
6615 | }
|
---|
6616 |
|
---|
6617 | @mastersthesis{Till89,
|
---|
6618 | keywords = {C, multiple return values, tuples},
|
---|
6619 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6620 | author = {David W. Till},
|
---|
6621 | title = {Tuples In Imperative Programming Languages},
|
---|
6622 | school = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo},
|
---|
6623 | year = 1989,
|
---|
6624 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1},
|
---|
6625 | }
|
---|
6626 |
|
---|
6627 | @article{turing:old,
|
---|
6628 | keywords = {verification, context conditions, faithful execution},
|
---|
6629 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6630 | author = {R. C. Holt and J. R. Cordy},
|
---|
6631 | title = {The Turing Programming Language},
|
---|
6632 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
6633 | year = 1988,
|
---|
6634 | month = dec,
|
---|
6635 | volume = 31, number = 12, pages = {1410-1423}
|
---|
6636 | }
|
---|
6637 |
|
---|
6638 | @book{Turing,
|
---|
6639 | keywords = {verification, context conditions, faithful execution},
|
---|
6640 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6641 | author = {R. C. Holt},
|
---|
6642 | title = {Turing Reference Manual},
|
---|
6643 | publisher = {Holt Software Associates Inc.},
|
---|
6644 | year = 1992,
|
---|
6645 | edition = {3rd},
|
---|
6646 | }
|
---|
6647 |
|
---|
6648 | @techreport{Dijkstra79,
|
---|
6649 | keywords = {split binary semaphores},
|
---|
6650 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6651 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra},
|
---|
6652 | title = {A Tutorial on the Split Binary Semaphore},
|
---|
6653 | institution = {Nuenen},
|
---|
6654 | address = {Netherlands},
|
---|
6655 | number = {EWD703},
|
---|
6656 | month = mar,
|
---|
6657 | year = 1979,
|
---|
6658 | }
|
---|
6659 |
|
---|
6660 | @book{pldesign,
|
---|
6661 | keywords = {},
|
---|
6662 | editor = {Anthony I. Wasserman},
|
---|
6663 | title = {Tutorial: Programming Language Design},
|
---|
6664 | publisher = {Computer Society Press},
|
---|
6665 | address = {Los Alamitos},
|
---|
6666 | year = 1980
|
---|
6667 | }
|
---|
6668 |
|
---|
6669 | @article{Leroy00,
|
---|
6670 | keywords = {type-systems, exceptions},
|
---|
6671 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6672 | author = {Xavier Leroy and Fran\c{c}ois Pessaux},
|
---|
6673 | title = {Type-Based Analysis of Uncaught Exceptions},
|
---|
6674 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
6675 | month = mar,
|
---|
6676 | year = 2000,
|
---|
6677 | volume = 22,
|
---|
6678 | number = 2,
|
---|
6679 | pages = {340-377},
|
---|
6680 | comment = {
|
---|
6681 | Argues against declaring exceptions on routine definitions.
|
---|
6682 | },
|
---|
6683 | }
|
---|
6684 |
|
---|
6685 | @article{Cormack90,
|
---|
6686 | keywords = {polymorphism},
|
---|
6687 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6688 | author = {G. V. Cormack and A. K. Wright},
|
---|
6689 | title = {Type-dependent Parameter Inference},
|
---|
6690 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
6691 | volume = 25,
|
---|
6692 | number = 6,
|
---|
6693 | month = jun,
|
---|
6694 | year = 1990,
|
---|
6695 | pages = {127-136},
|
---|
6696 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM Sigplan'90 Conference on Programming Language Design and Implementation
|
---|
6697 | June 20-22, 1990, White Plains, New York, U.S.A.},
|
---|
6698 | }
|
---|
6699 |
|
---|
6700 | @article{concatenation,
|
---|
6701 | keywords = {record concatenation, isa},
|
---|
6702 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6703 | author = {N. Wirth},
|
---|
6704 | title = {Type Extensions},
|
---|
6705 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
6706 | volume = {10},
|
---|
6707 | number = {2},
|
---|
6708 | pages = {204-214},
|
---|
6709 | month = apr, year = 1988,
|
---|
6710 | comment = {
|
---|
6711 | Extended record types add fields to their base record. Assignment
|
---|
6712 | truncations. Pointers can point at extended type instances. For
|
---|
6713 | polymorphism, call by value is assignment, and call by reference is
|
---|
6714 | pointer passing. Overloading isn't discussed. Type information
|
---|
6715 | can be recovered through an ``is'' type test or through type guards
|
---|
6716 | (casts). A version of the WITH statement could avoid repeated
|
---|
6717 | checking.
|
---|
6718 |
|
---|
6719 | Private/public access to record fields can be provided by exporting
|
---|
6720 | a base type, and using a private extension. Statically allocated
|
---|
6721 | instances need a compiler hint specifying the maximum size of the
|
---|
6722 | private type.
|
---|
6723 |
|
---|
6724 | Type checking is cheap (if the creation of pointer values is
|
---|
6725 | controlled). Types have type descriptors. Extension descriptors
|
---|
6726 | point at their direct base. Heap objects point at their
|
---|
6727 | descriptor, and reference parameters are accompanied by type
|
---|
6728 | descriptor parameters. ``v is t0'' loops along the chain of
|
---|
6729 | descriptors.
|
---|
6730 | }
|
---|
6731 | }
|
---|
6732 |
|
---|
6733 | % U
|
---|
6734 |
|
---|
6735 | @book{uC++book,
|
---|
6736 | keywords = {control structure, concurrency, uC++},
|
---|
6737 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6738 | author = {Peter A. Buhr},
|
---|
6739 | title = {Understanding Control Flow: Concurrent Programming using $\mu${C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}},
|
---|
6740 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
6741 | address = {Switzerland},
|
---|
6742 | year = 2016,
|
---|
6743 | }
|
---|
6744 |
|
---|
6745 | @article{Cardelli85,
|
---|
6746 | keywords = {polymorphism},
|
---|
6747 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6748 | author = {Luca Cardelli and Peter Wegner},
|
---|
6749 | title = {On Understanding Types, Data Abstractions, and Polymorphism},
|
---|
6750 | journal = acmcs,
|
---|
6751 | month = dec,
|
---|
6752 | year = 1985,
|
---|
6753 | volume = 17,
|
---|
6754 | number = 4,
|
---|
6755 | pages = {471-522},
|
---|
6756 | }
|
---|
6757 |
|
---|
6758 | @inproceedings{Wilson92,
|
---|
6759 | keywords = {garbage collection survey},
|
---|
6760 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6761 | author = {Paul R. Wilson},
|
---|
6762 | title = {Uniprocessor Garbage Collection Techniques},
|
---|
6763 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the International Workshop on Memory Management},
|
---|
6764 | location = {St. Malo, France},
|
---|
6765 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
6766 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science},
|
---|
6767 | volume = 637,
|
---|
6768 | month = sep,
|
---|
6769 | year = {1992},
|
---|
6770 | pages = {1-42},
|
---|
6771 | }
|
---|
6772 |
|
---|
6773 | @inproceedings{Hewitt73,
|
---|
6774 | author = {Carl Hewitt and Peter Bishop and Richard Steiger},
|
---|
6775 | title = {A Universal Modular {ACTOR} Formalism for Artificial Intelligence},
|
---|
6776 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 3rd International Joint Conference on Artificial Intelligence},
|
---|
6777 | address = {Standford, California, U.S.A.},
|
---|
6778 | pages = {235-245},
|
---|
6779 | month = aug,
|
---|
6780 | year = 1973,
|
---|
6781 | }
|
---|
6782 |
|
---|
6783 | @article{Bourne78,
|
---|
6784 | keywords = {Shell},
|
---|
6785 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6786 | author = {S. R. Bourne},
|
---|
6787 | title = {The UNIX Shell},
|
---|
6788 | journal = {The Bell System Technical Journal},
|
---|
6789 | volume = {57, part 2},
|
---|
6790 | month = {July--August},
|
---|
6791 | year = 1978,
|
---|
6792 | pages = {1971-1990},
|
---|
6793 | }
|
---|
6794 |
|
---|
6795 | @inproceedings{Krischer12,
|
---|
6796 | keywords = {exception, usability, asynchronous, assertion, injection, logging},
|
---|
6797 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6798 | author = {Roy Krischer and Peter A. Buhr},
|
---|
6799 | title = {Usability Challenges in Exception Handling},
|
---|
6800 | booktitle = {5th International Workshop on Exception Handling (WEH)},
|
---|
6801 | organization= {16th International Symposium on the Foundations of Software Engineering (FSE 16)},
|
---|
6802 | address = {Zurich, Switzerland},
|
---|
6803 | month = jun,
|
---|
6804 | year = 2012,
|
---|
6805 | pages = {7-13},
|
---|
6806 | }
|
---|
6807 |
|
---|
6808 | @techreport{Harmony,
|
---|
6809 | keywords = {messages, concurrency},
|
---|
6810 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6811 | author = {W. Morven Gentleman},
|
---|
6812 | title = {Using the Harmony Operating System},
|
---|
6813 | institution = {National Research Council of Canada, Ottawa, Canada},
|
---|
6814 | number = {24685},
|
---|
6815 | month = may,
|
---|
6816 | year = 1985
|
---|
6817 | }
|
---|
6818 |
|
---|
6819 | @article{delegation,
|
---|
6820 | keywords = {delegation, inheritance, actors},
|
---|
6821 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6822 | author = {Henry Lieverman},
|
---|
6823 | title = {Using Prototypical Objects to Implement Shared Behavior in
|
---|
6824 | Object Oriented Systems},
|
---|
6825 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
6826 | month = nov, year = 1986,
|
---|
6827 | volume = 21, number = 11, pages = {214-223}
|
---|
6828 | }
|
---|
6829 |
|
---|
6830 | % V
|
---|
6831 |
|
---|
6832 | @article{V-Kernel,
|
---|
6833 | keywords = {messages, concurrency},
|
---|
6834 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6835 | author = {David R. Cheriton},
|
---|
6836 | title = {The {V} Distributed System},
|
---|
6837 | journal = cacm,
|
---|
6838 | month = mar,
|
---|
6839 | year = 1988,
|
---|
6840 | volume = 31,
|
---|
6841 | number = 3,
|
---|
6842 | pages = {314-333}
|
---|
6843 | }
|
---|
6844 |
|
---|
6845 | @inproceedings{Amdahl67,
|
---|
6846 | author = {Gene M. Amdahl},
|
---|
6847 | title = {Validity of the Single Processor Approach to Achieving Large Scale Computing Capabilities},
|
---|
6848 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the April 18-20, 1967, Spring Joint Computer Conference},
|
---|
6849 | series = {AFIPS '67 (Spring)},
|
---|
6850 | year = 1967,
|
---|
6851 | location = {Atlantic City, New Jersey},
|
---|
6852 | pages = {483--485},
|
---|
6853 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
6854 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
6855 | }
|
---|
6856 |
|
---|
6857 | @article{Mayer81,
|
---|
6858 | keywords = {},
|
---|
6859 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6860 | author = {A. J. W. Mayer},
|
---|
6861 | title = {Value Receiving Procedures},
|
---|
6862 | journal = sigplan,
|
---|
6863 | volume = 16,
|
---|
6864 | number = 11,
|
---|
6865 | month = nov,
|
---|
6866 | year = 1981,
|
---|
6867 | pages = {30-34},
|
---|
6868 | }
|
---|
6869 |
|
---|
6870 | @article{Doran80,
|
---|
6871 | keywords = {concurrency, Dekker's Algorithm},
|
---|
6872 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6873 | author = {R. W. Doran and L. K. Thomas},
|
---|
6874 | title = {Variants of the Software Solution to Mutual Exclusion},
|
---|
6875 | journal = ipl,
|
---|
6876 | month = jul,
|
---|
6877 | year = 1980,
|
---|
6878 | volume = 10,
|
---|
6879 | number = {4/5},
|
---|
6880 | pages = {206-208},
|
---|
6881 | }
|
---|
6882 |
|
---|
6883 | @book{VAX,
|
---|
6884 | keywords = {VAX, DEC},
|
---|
6885 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6886 | key = {VAX},
|
---|
6887 | title = {VAX-11 Architecture Reference Manual},
|
---|
6888 | publisher = {Digital Press},
|
---|
6889 | address = {Bedford},
|
---|
6890 | month = may,
|
---|
6891 | year = 1982,
|
---|
6892 | }
|
---|
6893 |
|
---|
6894 | @book{Kenah88,
|
---|
6895 | author = {Lawrence J. Kenah and Ruth E. Goldenberg and Simon F. Bate},
|
---|
6896 | title = {{VAX/VMS} Internals and Data Structures Version 4.4},
|
---|
6897 | publisher = {Digital Press},
|
---|
6898 | address = {Bedford},
|
---|
6899 | year = 1988,
|
---|
6900 | }
|
---|
6901 |
|
---|
6902 | @article{Hesselink13,
|
---|
6903 | keywords = {software solutions, N-thread, mutual exclusions},
|
---|
6904 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6905 | author = {Wim H. Hesselink},
|
---|
6906 | title = {Verifying a Simplification of Mutual Exclusion by {L}ycklama--{H}adzilacos},
|
---|
6907 | journal = {Acta Informatica},
|
---|
6908 | publisher = {Springer},
|
---|
6909 | address = {New York},
|
---|
6910 | year = {2013},
|
---|
6911 | volume = {50},
|
---|
6912 | number = {3},
|
---|
6913 | pages = {199-228},
|
---|
6914 | }
|
---|
6915 |
|
---|
6916 | % W
|
---|
6917 |
|
---|
6918 | @article{Herlihy91,
|
---|
6919 | keywords = {linearization, wait-free synchronization},
|
---|
6920 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6921 | author = {Maurice Herlihy},
|
---|
6922 | title = {Wait-free Synchronization},
|
---|
6923 | journal = toplas,
|
---|
6924 | volume = {13},
|
---|
6925 | number = {1},
|
---|
6926 | month = jan,
|
---|
6927 | year = 1991,
|
---|
6928 | pages = {124--149},
|
---|
6929 | numpages = {26},
|
---|
6930 | publisher = {ACM},
|
---|
6931 | address = {New York, NY, USA},
|
---|
6932 | }
|
---|
6933 |
|
---|
6934 | @techreport{Moss90,
|
---|
6935 | keywords = {Swizzling, database},
|
---|
6936 | contributer = {akgoel@plg},
|
---|
6937 | author = {J. Moss},
|
---|
6938 | title = {Working with Persistent Objects: To Swizzle or Not to Swizzle},
|
---|
6939 | institution = {CS Department, University of Massachusetts},
|
---|
6940 | address = {},
|
---|
6941 | number = {CS 90-38},
|
---|
6942 | month = may,
|
---|
6943 | year = 1990,
|
---|
6944 | }
|
---|
6945 |
|
---|
6946 | @inproceedings{Str:oop,
|
---|
6947 | keywords = { },
|
---|
6948 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6949 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
6950 | title = {What is ``Object-Oriented Programming''?},
|
---|
6951 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the First European Conference on Object Oriented Programming},
|
---|
6952 | month = jun,
|
---|
6953 | year = 1987
|
---|
6954 | }
|
---|
6955 |
|
---|
6956 | @misc{Stroustrup:overloading,
|
---|
6957 | keywords = {operator overloading},
|
---|
6958 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6959 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup},
|
---|
6960 | title = {Why can't I overload dot, ::, sizeof, etc.?},
|
---|
6961 | month = oct,
|
---|
6962 | year = 2007,
|
---|
6963 | howpublished= {{\small\textsf{http://\-www.research.att.com/\-bs/\-bs\_faq2.html\-\#overload-dot}}},
|
---|
6964 | }
|
---|
6965 |
|
---|
6966 | @techreport{Gray85,
|
---|
6967 | keywords = {fault-tolerant system},
|
---|
6968 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg},
|
---|
6969 | author = {Jim Gray},
|
---|
6970 | title = {Why Do Computers Stop and What Can Be Done About It?},
|
---|
6971 | institution = {Tandem Computers},
|
---|
6972 | number = {85.7 PN87614},
|
---|
6973 | month = jun,
|
---|
6974 | year = 1985,
|
---|
6975 | note = {\href{http://www.hpl.hp.com/techreports/tandem/TR-85.7.pdf}{http://www.hpl.hp.com/\-techreports/\-tandem/\-TR-85.7.pdf}},
|
---|
6976 | }
|
---|
6977 |
|
---|
6978 | % X
|
---|
6979 |
|
---|
6980 | % Y
|
---|
6981 |
|
---|
6982 | % Z
|
---|
6983 |
|
---|
6984 | % Cross-referenced entries:
|
---|
6985 |
|
---|
6986 | % O
|
---|
6987 |
|
---|
6988 | % The SIGPLAN Notices issue should be in a note field, but notes are
|
---|
6989 | % inherited by all refering entries, instead of being held in the
|
---|
6990 | % cross-referenced entry. Putting it in "publisher" is a kludge, but it
|
---|
6991 | % works.
|
---|
6992 | @proceedings{OOPSLA86,
|
---|
6993 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
6994 | title = {{OOPSLA} '86 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
6995 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '86 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
6996 | year = 1986,
|
---|
6997 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz},
|
---|
6998 | publisher = sigplan # " 21(11)",
|
---|
6999 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
7000 | address = {Portland, Oregon},
|
---|
7001 | month = sep # { 29}
|
---|
7002 | }
|
---|
7003 |
|
---|
7004 | @proceedings{OOPSLA87,
|
---|
7005 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
7006 | title = {{OOPSLA} '87 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7007 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '87 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7008 | year = 1987,
|
---|
7009 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz},
|
---|
7010 | publisher = sigplan # " 22(12)",
|
---|
7011 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
7012 | address = {Orlando, Florida},
|
---|
7013 | month = oct # { 4--8}
|
---|
7014 | }
|
---|
7015 |
|
---|
7016 | @proceedings{OOPSLA88,
|
---|
7017 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
7018 | title = {{OOPSLA} '88 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7019 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '88 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7020 | year = 1988,
|
---|
7021 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz},
|
---|
7022 | publisher = sigplan # " 23(11)",
|
---|
7023 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
7024 | address = {San Diego, California},
|
---|
7025 | month = sep # { 25--30}
|
---|
7026 | }
|
---|
7027 |
|
---|
7028 | @proceedings{OOPSLA89,
|
---|
7029 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
7030 | title = {{OOPSLA} '89 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7031 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '89 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7032 | year = 1989,
|
---|
7033 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz},
|
---|
7034 | publisher = sigplan # " 24(10)",
|
---|
7035 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
7036 | address = {New Orleans, Louisiana},
|
---|
7037 | month = oct # { 1--6}
|
---|
7038 | }
|
---|
7039 |
|
---|
7040 | @proceedings{OOPSLA90,
|
---|
7041 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
7042 | title = {{OOPSLA/ECOOP} '90 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7043 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '90 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7044 | year = 1990,
|
---|
7045 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz},
|
---|
7046 | publisher = sigplan # " 25(10)",
|
---|
7047 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
7048 | address = {Ottawa, Canada},
|
---|
7049 | month = oct # { 21--25}
|
---|
7050 | }
|
---|
7051 |
|
---|
7052 | @proceedings{OOPSLA91,
|
---|
7053 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg},
|
---|
7054 | title = {{OOPSLA} '91 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7055 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '91 Conference Proceedings},
|
---|
7056 | year = 1991,
|
---|
7057 | editor = {Andreas Paepcke},
|
---|
7058 | publisher = sigplan # " 26(11)",
|
---|
7059 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery},
|
---|
7060 | address = {Phoenix, Arizona},
|
---|
7061 | month = oct # { 6--11}
|
---|
7062 | }
|
---|